1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 25 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 30 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 31 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 35 #include <algorithm> 36 #include <cstdlib> 37 38 using namespace clang; 39 using namespace sema; 40 41 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 42 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 43 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 44 }); 45 } 46 47 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 48 static ExprResult 49 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 50 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 51 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 52 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 53 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 54 return ExprError(); 55 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 56 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 57 // called on both. 58 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 59 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 60 // being used. 61 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 62 return ExprError(); 63 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) 64 DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 65 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 66 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 67 68 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 69 if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 70 if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) { 71 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 72 DRE->setType(Fn->getType()); 73 } 74 } 75 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 76 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 77 } 78 79 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 80 bool InOverloadResolution, 81 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 82 bool CStyle, 83 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 84 85 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 86 QualType &ToType, 87 bool InOverloadResolution, 88 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 89 bool CStyle); 90 static OverloadingResult 91 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 92 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 93 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 94 bool AllowExplicit, 95 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 96 97 98 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 99 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 100 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 101 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 102 103 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 104 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 105 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 106 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 107 108 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 109 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 110 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 111 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 112 113 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 114 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 115 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 116 static const ImplicitConversionRank 117 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 118 ICR_Exact_Match, 119 ICR_Exact_Match, 120 ICR_Exact_Match, 121 ICR_Exact_Match, 122 ICR_Exact_Match, 123 ICR_Exact_Match, 124 ICR_Promotion, 125 ICR_Promotion, 126 ICR_Promotion, 127 ICR_Conversion, 128 ICR_Conversion, 129 ICR_Conversion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_Conversion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 138 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 142 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 143 // it was omitted by the patch that added 144 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 145 ICR_C_Conversion, 146 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 147 }; 148 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 149 } 150 151 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 152 /// implicit conversion. 153 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 154 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 155 "No conversion", 156 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 157 "Array-to-pointer", 158 "Function-to-pointer", 159 "Function pointer conversion", 160 "Qualification", 161 "Integral promotion", 162 "Floating point promotion", 163 "Complex promotion", 164 "Integral conversion", 165 "Floating conversion", 166 "Complex conversion", 167 "Floating-integral conversion", 168 "Pointer conversion", 169 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 170 "Boolean conversion", 171 "Compatible-types conversion", 172 "Derived-to-base conversion", 173 "Vector conversion", 174 "Vector splat", 175 "Complex-real conversion", 176 "Block Pointer conversion", 177 "Transparent Union Conversion", 178 "Writeback conversion", 179 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 180 "C specific type conversion", 181 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 182 }; 183 return Name[Kind]; 184 } 185 186 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 187 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 188 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 189 First = ICK_Identity; 190 Second = ICK_Identity; 191 Third = ICK_Identity; 192 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 193 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 194 ReferenceBinding = false; 195 DirectBinding = false; 196 IsLvalueReference = true; 197 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 198 BindsToRvalue = false; 199 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 200 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 201 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 202 } 203 204 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 205 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 206 /// implicit conversions. 207 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 208 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 209 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 210 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 211 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 212 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 213 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 214 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 215 return Rank; 216 } 217 218 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 219 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 220 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 221 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 222 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 223 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 224 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 225 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 226 // a pointer. 227 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 228 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 229 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 230 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 231 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 232 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 233 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 234 return true; 235 236 return false; 237 } 238 239 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 240 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 241 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 242 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 243 bool 244 StandardConversionSequence:: 245 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 246 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 247 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 248 249 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 250 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 251 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 252 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 253 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 254 255 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 256 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 257 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 258 259 return false; 260 } 261 262 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 263 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 264 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx, 265 const Expr *Converted) { 266 // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be 267 // preserved so that destructors run if necessary. 268 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) { 269 Expr *Inner = 270 const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr())); 271 return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), 272 EWC->getObjects()); 273 } 274 275 while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 276 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 277 case CK_NoOp: 278 case CK_IntegralCast: 279 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 280 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 281 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 282 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 283 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 284 case CK_FloatingCast: 285 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 286 continue; 287 288 default: 289 return Converted; 290 } 291 } 292 293 return Converted; 294 } 295 296 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 297 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 298 /// 299 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 300 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 301 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 302 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 303 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 304 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 305 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 306 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 307 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 308 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 309 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 310 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 311 312 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 313 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 314 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 315 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 316 317 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 318 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 319 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 320 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 321 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 322 323 switch (Second) { 324 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 325 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 326 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 327 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 328 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 329 goto IntegralConversion; 330 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 331 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 332 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 333 334 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 335 // 336 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 337 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 338 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 339 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 340 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 341 FloatingIntegralConversion: 342 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 343 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 344 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 345 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 346 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 347 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 348 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 349 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 350 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 351 352 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 353 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 354 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 355 356 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 357 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 358 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 359 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 360 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 361 // And back. 362 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 363 bool ignored; 364 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 365 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 366 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 367 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 368 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 369 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 370 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 371 } 372 } else { 373 // Variables are always narrowings. 374 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 375 } 376 } 377 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 378 379 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 380 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 381 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 382 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 383 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 384 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 385 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 386 // FromType is larger than ToType. 387 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 388 389 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 390 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 391 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 392 393 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 394 // Constant! 395 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 396 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 397 // Convert the source value into the target type. 398 bool ignored; 399 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 400 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 401 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 402 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 403 // values that can be represented. 404 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 405 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 406 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 407 } 408 } else { 409 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 410 } 411 } 412 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 413 414 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 415 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 416 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 417 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 418 // value when converted back to the original type. 419 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 420 IntegralConversion: { 421 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 422 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 423 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 424 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 425 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 426 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 427 428 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 429 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 430 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 431 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 432 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 433 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 434 435 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 436 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 437 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 438 439 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 440 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 441 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 442 } 443 bool Narrowing = false; 444 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 445 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 446 // narrowing. 447 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 448 Narrowing = true; 449 } else { 450 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 451 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 452 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 453 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 454 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 455 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 456 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 457 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 458 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 459 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 460 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 461 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 462 Narrowing = true; 463 } 464 if (Narrowing) { 465 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 466 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 467 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 468 } 469 } 470 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 471 } 472 473 default: 474 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 475 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 476 } 477 } 478 479 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 480 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 481 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 482 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 483 bool PrintedSomething = false; 484 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 485 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 486 PrintedSomething = true; 487 } 488 489 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 490 if (PrintedSomething) { 491 OS << " -> "; 492 } 493 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 494 495 if (CopyConstructor) { 496 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 497 } else if (DirectBinding) { 498 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 499 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 500 OS << " (reference binding)"; 501 } 502 PrintedSomething = true; 503 } 504 505 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 506 if (PrintedSomething) { 507 OS << " -> "; 508 } 509 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 510 PrintedSomething = true; 511 } 512 513 if (!PrintedSomething) { 514 OS << "No conversions required"; 515 } 516 } 517 518 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 519 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 520 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 521 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 522 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 523 Before.dump(); 524 OS << " -> "; 525 } 526 if (ConversionFunction) 527 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 528 else 529 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 530 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 531 OS << " -> "; 532 After.dump(); 533 } 534 } 535 536 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 537 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 538 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 539 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 540 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 541 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 542 switch (ConversionKind) { 543 case StandardConversion: 544 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 545 Standard.dump(); 546 break; 547 case UserDefinedConversion: 548 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 549 UserDefined.dump(); 550 break; 551 case EllipsisConversion: 552 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 553 break; 554 case AmbiguousConversion: 555 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 556 break; 557 case BadConversion: 558 OS << "Bad conversion"; 559 break; 560 } 561 562 OS << "\n"; 563 } 564 565 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 566 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 567 } 568 569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 570 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 571 } 572 573 void 574 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 575 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 576 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 577 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 578 } 579 580 namespace { 581 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 582 // template argument information. 583 struct DFIArguments { 584 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 585 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 586 }; 587 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 588 // template parameter and template argument information. 589 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 590 TemplateParameter Param; 591 }; 592 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 593 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 594 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 595 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 596 unsigned CallArgIndex; 597 }; 598 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about 599 // unsatisfied constraints. 600 struct CNSInfo { 601 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 602 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 603 }; 604 } 605 606 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 607 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 608 DeductionFailureInfo 609 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 610 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 611 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 612 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 613 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 614 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 615 switch (TDK) { 616 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 617 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 618 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 619 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 620 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 621 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 622 Result.Data = nullptr; 623 break; 624 625 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 626 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 627 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 628 break; 629 630 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 631 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 632 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 633 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 634 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 635 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 636 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 637 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 638 Result.Data = Saved; 639 break; 640 } 641 642 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 643 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 644 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 645 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 646 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 647 Result.Data = Saved; 648 break; 649 } 650 651 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 652 // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this. 653 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 654 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 655 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 656 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 657 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 658 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 659 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 660 Result.Data = Saved; 661 break; 662 } 663 664 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 665 Result.Data = Info.take(); 666 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 667 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 668 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 669 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 670 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 671 } 672 break; 673 674 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 675 CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo; 676 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 677 Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction; 678 Result.Data = Saved; 679 break; 680 } 681 682 case Sema::TDK_Success: 683 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 684 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 685 } 686 687 return Result; 688 } 689 690 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 691 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 692 case Sema::TDK_Success: 693 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 694 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 695 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 696 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 697 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 698 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 699 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 700 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 701 break; 702 703 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 704 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 705 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 706 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 707 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 708 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 709 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 710 Data = nullptr; 711 break; 712 713 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 714 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 715 Data = nullptr; 716 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 717 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 718 HasDiagnostic = false; 719 } 720 break; 721 722 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 723 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 724 Data = nullptr; 725 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 726 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 727 HasDiagnostic = false; 728 } 729 break; 730 731 // Unhandled 732 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 733 break; 734 } 735 } 736 737 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 738 if (HasDiagnostic) 739 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 740 return nullptr; 741 } 742 743 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 744 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 745 case Sema::TDK_Success: 746 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 747 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 748 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 749 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 750 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 751 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 752 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 753 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 754 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 755 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 756 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 757 return TemplateParameter(); 758 759 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 760 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 761 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 762 763 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 764 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 765 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 766 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 767 768 // Unhandled 769 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 770 break; 771 } 772 773 return TemplateParameter(); 774 } 775 776 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 777 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 778 case Sema::TDK_Success: 779 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 780 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 781 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 782 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 783 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 784 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 785 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 786 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 787 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 788 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 789 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 790 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 791 return nullptr; 792 793 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 794 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 795 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 796 797 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 798 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 799 800 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 801 return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 802 803 // Unhandled 804 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 805 break; 806 } 807 808 return nullptr; 809 } 810 811 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 812 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 813 case Sema::TDK_Success: 814 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 815 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 816 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 817 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 818 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 819 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 820 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 821 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 822 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 823 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 824 return nullptr; 825 826 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 827 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 828 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 829 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 830 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 831 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 832 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 833 834 // Unhandled 835 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 836 break; 837 } 838 839 return nullptr; 840 } 841 842 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 843 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 844 case Sema::TDK_Success: 845 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 846 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 847 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 848 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 849 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 850 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 851 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 852 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 853 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 854 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 855 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 856 return nullptr; 857 858 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 859 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 860 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 861 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 862 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 863 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 864 865 // Unhandled 866 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 867 break; 868 } 869 870 return nullptr; 871 } 872 873 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 874 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 875 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 876 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 877 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 878 879 default: 880 return llvm::None; 881 } 882 } 883 884 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 885 OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 886 if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates) 887 return false; 888 return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship; 889 } 890 891 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 892 ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 893 if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator())) 894 return false; 895 // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better 896 // match than the non-reversed version. 897 return FD->getNumParams() != 2 || 898 !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(), 899 FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) || 900 FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 901 } 902 903 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 904 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 905 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 906 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 907 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 908 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 909 } 910 } 911 912 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 913 destroyCandidates(); 914 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 915 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 916 Candidates.clear(); 917 Functions.clear(); 918 Kind = CSK; 919 } 920 921 namespace { 922 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 923 struct Entry { 924 Expr **Addr; 925 Expr *Saved; 926 }; 927 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 928 929 public: 930 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 931 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 932 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 933 Entries.push_back(entry); 934 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 935 } 936 937 void restore() { 938 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 939 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 940 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 941 } 942 }; 943 } 944 945 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 946 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 947 /// 948 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 949 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 950 /// 951 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 952 static bool 953 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 954 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 955 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 956 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 957 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 958 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 959 960 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 961 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 962 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 963 unbridgedCasts) { 964 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 965 return false; 966 } 967 968 // Go ahead and check everything else. 969 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 970 if (result.isInvalid()) 971 return true; 972 973 E = result.get(); 974 return false; 975 } 976 977 // Nothing to do. 978 return false; 979 } 980 981 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 982 /// placeholders. 983 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 984 MultiExprArg Args, 985 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 986 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 987 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 988 return true; 989 990 return false; 991 } 992 993 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 994 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 995 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 996 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 997 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 998 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 999 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 1000 /// declaration. 1001 /// 1002 /// Example: Given the following input: 1003 /// 1004 /// void f(int, float); // #1 1005 /// void f(int, int); // #2 1006 /// int f(int, int); // #3 1007 /// 1008 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 1009 /// will not be used. 1010 /// 1011 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 1012 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 1013 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 1014 /// unchanged. 1015 /// 1016 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 1017 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 1018 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 1019 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 1020 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 1021 /// 1022 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 1023 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 1024 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 1025 /// signature. 1026 Sema::OverloadKind 1027 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 1028 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 1029 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 1030 I != E; ++I) { 1031 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 1032 1033 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 1034 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 1035 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 1036 1037 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 1038 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 1039 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 1040 1041 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 1042 } 1043 1044 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 1045 // if one of them is hidden. 1046 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 1047 continue; 1048 1049 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 1050 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 1051 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 1052 // function templates hide function templates with different 1053 // return types or template parameter lists. 1054 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 1055 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 1056 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 1057 1058 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 1059 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 1060 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 1061 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 1062 continue; 1063 } 1064 1065 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 1066 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 1067 continue; 1068 1069 Match = *I; 1070 return Ovl_Match; 1071 } 1072 1073 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1074 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1075 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1076 Match = *I; 1077 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1078 } 1079 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1080 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1081 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1082 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1083 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1084 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1085 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1086 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1087 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1088 // template instantiation. 1089 // 1090 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1091 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1092 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1093 Match = *I; 1094 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1095 } 1096 } else { 1097 // (C++ 13p1): 1098 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1099 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1100 Match = *I; 1101 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1102 } 1103 } 1104 1105 // C++ [temp.friend]p1: 1106 // For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration: 1107 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id, 1108 // [...], otherwise 1109 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching 1110 // non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace, 1111 // the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise, 1112 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function 1113 // template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend 1114 // declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function 1115 // template, otherwise 1116 // -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...] 1117 // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the 1118 // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup 1119 // until instantiation. 1120 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() && 1121 !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 1122 !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() && 1123 !New->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1124 LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old); 1125 TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old); 1126 if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult, 1127 /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) { 1128 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1129 return Ovl_Overload; 1130 } 1131 1132 Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>(); 1133 return Ovl_Match; 1134 } 1135 1136 return Ovl_Overload; 1137 } 1138 1139 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1140 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs, 1141 bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1142 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1143 if (New->isMain()) 1144 return false; 1145 1146 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1147 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1148 return false; 1149 1150 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1151 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1152 1153 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1154 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1155 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1156 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1157 return true; 1158 1159 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1160 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1161 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1162 1163 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1164 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1165 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1166 1167 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1168 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1169 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1170 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1171 return false; 1172 1173 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1174 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1175 1176 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1177 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1178 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1179 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1180 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1181 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1182 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1183 return true; 1184 1185 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1186 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1187 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1188 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1189 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1190 // signature. 1191 // 1192 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1193 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1194 // 1195 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1196 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1197 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1198 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1199 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1200 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1201 !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(), 1202 New->getDeclaredReturnType()))) 1203 return true; 1204 1205 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1206 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1207 // 1208 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1209 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1210 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1211 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1212 // can be overloaded. 1213 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1214 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1215 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1216 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1217 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1218 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1219 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1220 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1221 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1222 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1223 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1224 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1225 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1226 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1227 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1228 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1229 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1230 } 1231 return true; 1232 } 1233 1234 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1235 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1236 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1237 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1238 auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1239 auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1240 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1241 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1242 NewQuals.addConst(); 1243 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1244 OldQuals.removeRestrict(); 1245 NewQuals.removeRestrict(); 1246 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1247 return true; 1248 } 1249 1250 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1251 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1252 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1253 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1254 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1255 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1256 return true; 1257 1258 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1259 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1260 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1261 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1262 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1263 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1264 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1265 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1266 return true; 1267 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1268 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1269 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1270 if (NewID != OldID) 1271 return true; 1272 } 1273 1274 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1275 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1276 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1277 if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) { 1278 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1279 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1280 if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) { 1281 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && 1282 "Unexpected invalid target."); 1283 1284 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1285 // target attributes. 1286 if (NewTarget != OldTarget) 1287 return true; 1288 } 1289 } 1290 } 1291 1292 if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1293 Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(), 1294 *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 1295 if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr)) 1296 // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads. 1297 return true; 1298 1299 if (NewRC) { 1300 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1301 NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1302 OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1303 if (NewID != OldID) 1304 // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads. 1305 return true; 1306 } 1307 } 1308 1309 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1310 return false; 1311 } 1312 1313 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1314 /// 1315 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1316 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1317 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1318 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1319 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1320 bool AllowExplicit, 1321 bool InOverloadResolution, 1322 bool CStyle, 1323 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1324 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1325 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1326 1327 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1328 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1329 // we can perform. 1330 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1331 return ICS; 1332 } 1333 1334 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1335 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1336 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1337 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1338 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1339 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1340 case OR_Success: 1341 case OR_Deleted: 1342 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1343 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1344 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1345 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1346 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1347 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1348 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1349 // called for those cases. 1350 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1351 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1352 QualType FromCanon 1353 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1354 QualType ToCanon 1355 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1356 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1357 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1358 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1359 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1360 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1361 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1362 ICS.setStandard(); 1363 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1364 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1365 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1366 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1367 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1368 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1369 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1370 } 1371 } 1372 break; 1373 1374 case OR_Ambiguous: 1375 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1376 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1377 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1378 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1379 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1380 if (Cand->Best) 1381 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1382 break; 1383 1384 // Fall through. 1385 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1386 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1387 break; 1388 } 1389 1390 return ICS; 1391 } 1392 1393 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1394 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1395 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1396 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1397 /// 1398 /// void f(float f); 1399 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1400 /// 1401 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1402 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1403 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1404 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1405 // 1406 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1407 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1408 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1409 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1410 /// "BadConversion". 1411 /// 1412 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1413 /// not permitted. 1414 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1415 /// permitted. 1416 /// 1417 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1418 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1419 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1420 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1421 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1422 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1423 bool AllowExplicit, 1424 bool InOverloadResolution, 1425 bool CStyle, 1426 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1427 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1428 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1429 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1430 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1431 ICS.setStandard(); 1432 return ICS; 1433 } 1434 1435 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1436 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1437 return ICS; 1438 } 1439 1440 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1441 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1442 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1443 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1444 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1445 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1446 // called for those cases. 1447 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1448 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1449 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1450 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) { 1451 ICS.setStandard(); 1452 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1453 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1454 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1455 1456 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1457 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1458 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1459 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1460 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1461 1462 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1463 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1464 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1465 1466 return ICS; 1467 } 1468 1469 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1470 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1471 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1472 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1473 } 1474 1475 ImplicitConversionSequence 1476 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1477 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1478 bool AllowExplicit, 1479 bool InOverloadResolution, 1480 bool CStyle, 1481 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1482 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1483 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 1484 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1485 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1486 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1487 } 1488 1489 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1490 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1491 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1492 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1493 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1494 ExprResult 1495 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1496 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 1497 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1498 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 1499 } 1500 1501 ExprResult 1502 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1503 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 1504 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 1505 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1506 return ExprError(); 1507 1508 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1509 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1510 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1511 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1512 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) 1513 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 1514 From->getType(), From); 1515 ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1516 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1517 AllowExplicit, 1518 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1519 /*CStyle=*/false, 1520 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1521 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1522 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1523 } 1524 1525 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1526 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1527 /// type. 1528 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1529 QualType &ResultTy) { 1530 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1531 return false; 1532 1533 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1534 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1535 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1536 // - a pointer 1537 // - a member pointer 1538 // - a block pointer 1539 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1540 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1541 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1542 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1543 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1544 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1545 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1546 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1547 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1548 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1549 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1550 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1551 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1552 auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1553 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1554 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1555 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1556 return false; 1557 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1558 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1559 } else { 1560 return false; 1561 } 1562 1563 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1564 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1565 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1566 return false; 1567 } 1568 1569 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1570 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1571 1572 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1573 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1574 1575 bool Changed = false; 1576 1577 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1578 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1579 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1580 Changed = true; 1581 } 1582 1583 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1584 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1585 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1586 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1587 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1588 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1589 EST_None) 1590 .getTypePtr()); 1591 Changed = true; 1592 } 1593 1594 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1595 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1596 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1597 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1598 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1599 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1600 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1601 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1602 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1603 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1604 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1605 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1606 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1607 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1608 Changed = true; 1609 } 1610 } 1611 1612 if (!Changed) 1613 return false; 1614 1615 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1616 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1617 1618 ResultTy = ToType; 1619 return true; 1620 } 1621 1622 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1623 /// vector conversion. 1624 /// 1625 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1626 /// conversion. 1627 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1628 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1629 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1630 // conversion. 1631 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1632 return false; 1633 1634 // Identical types require no conversions. 1635 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1636 return false; 1637 1638 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1639 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1640 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1641 // identity conversion. 1642 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1643 return false; 1644 1645 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1646 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1647 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1648 return true; 1649 } 1650 } 1651 1652 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1653 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1654 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1655 // same size 1656 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1657 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1658 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) { 1659 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1660 return true; 1661 } 1662 } 1663 1664 return false; 1665 } 1666 1667 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1668 bool InOverloadResolution, 1669 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1670 bool CStyle); 1671 1672 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1673 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1674 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1675 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1676 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1677 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1678 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1679 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1680 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1681 bool InOverloadResolution, 1682 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1683 bool CStyle, 1684 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1685 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1686 1687 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1688 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1689 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1690 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1691 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1692 1693 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1694 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1695 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1696 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1697 return false; 1698 1699 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1700 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1701 // (C++ 4p1). 1702 1703 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1704 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1705 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1706 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1707 AccessPair)) { 1708 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1709 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1710 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1711 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1712 1713 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1714 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1715 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1716 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1717 QualType resultTy; 1718 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1719 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1720 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1721 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1722 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1723 return false; 1724 } 1725 1726 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1727 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1728 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1729 // expression. 1730 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1731 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1732 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1733 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1734 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1735 == UO_AddrOf && 1736 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1737 const Type *ClassType 1738 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1739 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1740 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1741 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1742 UO_AddrOf && 1743 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1744 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1745 } 1746 1747 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1748 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1749 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1750 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1751 FromType, 1752 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1753 } else { 1754 return false; 1755 } 1756 } 1757 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1758 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1759 // be converted to a prvalue. 1760 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1761 if (argIsLValue && 1762 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1763 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1764 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1765 1766 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1767 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1768 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1769 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1770 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1771 1772 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1773 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1774 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1775 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1776 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1777 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1778 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1779 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1780 1781 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1782 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1783 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1784 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1785 1786 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1787 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1788 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1789 1790 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1791 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1792 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1793 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1794 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1795 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1796 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1797 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1798 return true; 1799 } 1800 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1801 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1802 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1803 1804 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1805 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1806 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1807 return false; 1808 1809 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1810 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1811 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1812 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1813 } else { 1814 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1815 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1816 } 1817 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1818 1819 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1820 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1821 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1822 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1823 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1824 // conversion. 1825 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1826 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1827 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1828 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1829 // conversion to do. 1830 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1831 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1832 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1833 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1834 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1835 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1836 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1837 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1838 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1839 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1840 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1841 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1842 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1843 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1844 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1845 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1846 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1847 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1848 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1849 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1850 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1851 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1852 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1853 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1854 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1855 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1856 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1857 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1858 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1859 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1860 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1861 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1862 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1863 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1864 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1865 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1866 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1867 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1868 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1869 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1870 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1871 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1872 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1873 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1874 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1875 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1876 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1877 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1878 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1879 return false; 1880 } 1881 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1882 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1883 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1884 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1885 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1886 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1887 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1888 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1889 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1890 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1891 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1892 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1893 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1894 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1895 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1896 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1897 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1898 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1899 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1900 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1901 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1902 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1903 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1904 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1905 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1906 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1907 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1908 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1909 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1910 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1911 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1912 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1913 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1914 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1915 InOverloadResolution, 1916 SCS, CStyle)) { 1917 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1918 FromType = ToType; 1919 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1920 CStyle)) { 1921 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1922 // appropriately. 1923 return true; 1924 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1925 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1926 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1927 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1928 FromType = ToType; 1929 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1930 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1931 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1932 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1933 FromType = ToType; 1934 } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() && 1935 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) { 1936 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1937 FromType = ToType; 1938 } else { 1939 // No second conversion required. 1940 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1941 } 1942 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1943 1944 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1945 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1946 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1947 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1948 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1949 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1950 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1951 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1952 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1953 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1954 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1955 FromType = ToType; 1956 } else { 1957 // No conversion required 1958 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1959 } 1960 1961 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1962 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1963 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1964 // a conversion. [...] 1965 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1966 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1967 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1968 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1969 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1970 FromType = ToType; 1971 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1972 } 1973 1974 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1975 1976 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1977 return true; 1978 1979 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1980 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1981 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1982 return false; 1983 1984 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1985 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1986 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 1987 /*Diagnose=*/false, 1988 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 1989 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 1990 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 1991 switch (Conv) { 1992 case Sema::Compatible: 1993 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 1994 break; 1995 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 1996 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 1997 // qualifiers, as well. 1998 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 1999 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 2000 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 2001 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 2002 break; 2003 default: 2004 return false; 2005 } 2006 2007 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 2008 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 2009 // function. 2010 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 2011 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 2012 2013 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 2014 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 2015 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 2016 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 2017 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 2018 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 2019 return true; 2020 } 2021 2022 static bool 2023 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 2024 QualType &ToType, 2025 bool InOverloadResolution, 2026 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2027 bool CStyle) { 2028 2029 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 2030 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 2031 return false; 2032 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 2033 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 2034 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 2035 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 2036 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 2037 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 2038 ToType = it->getType(); 2039 return true; 2040 } 2041 } 2042 return false; 2043 } 2044 2045 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 2046 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 2047 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 2048 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2049 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2050 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 2051 // All integers are built-in. 2052 if (!To) { 2053 return false; 2054 } 2055 2056 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 2057 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 2058 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 2059 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 2060 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 2061 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 2062 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 2063 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 2064 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 2065 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 2066 // less than int to an int. 2067 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 2068 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2069 } 2070 2071 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2072 } 2073 2074 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 2075 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 2076 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 2077 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 2078 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 2079 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 2080 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 2081 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 2082 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 2083 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 2084 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 2085 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 2086 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 2087 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 2088 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 2089 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 2090 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 2091 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 2092 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2093 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 2094 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 2095 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 2096 return false; 2097 2098 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 2099 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 2100 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 2101 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 2102 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2103 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2104 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2105 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2106 } 2107 2108 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2109 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2110 isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType)) 2111 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2112 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2113 2114 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 2115 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 2116 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 2117 // 2118 // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++. 2119 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2120 return false; 2121 } 2122 2123 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2124 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2125 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2126 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2127 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2128 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2129 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2130 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2131 // type. 2132 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2133 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2134 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2135 // unsigned. 2136 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2137 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2138 2139 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2140 // order. Try each of these types. 2141 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2142 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2143 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2144 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2145 }; 2146 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2147 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2148 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2149 (FromSize == ToSize && 2150 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2151 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2152 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2153 // promotion. 2154 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2155 } 2156 } 2157 } 2158 2159 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2160 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2161 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2162 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2163 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2164 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2165 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2166 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2167 // conversion. 2168 // 2169 // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be 2170 // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum 2171 // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC 2172 // compatibility. 2173 if (From) { 2174 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2175 llvm::APSInt BitWidth; 2176 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2177 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 2178 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 2179 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2180 2181 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2182 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 2183 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2184 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2185 } 2186 2187 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2188 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2189 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2190 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2191 } 2192 2193 return false; 2194 } 2195 } 2196 } 2197 2198 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2199 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2200 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2201 return true; 2202 } 2203 2204 return false; 2205 } 2206 2207 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2208 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2209 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2210 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2211 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2212 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2213 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2214 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2215 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2216 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2217 return true; 2218 2219 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2220 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2221 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2222 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2223 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2224 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2225 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2226 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2227 return true; 2228 2229 // Half can be promoted to float. 2230 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2231 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2232 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2233 return true; 2234 } 2235 2236 return false; 2237 } 2238 2239 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2240 /// 2241 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2242 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2243 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2244 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2245 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2246 if (!FromComplex) 2247 return false; 2248 2249 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2250 if (!ToComplex) 2251 return false; 2252 2253 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2254 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2255 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2256 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2257 } 2258 2259 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2260 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2261 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2262 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2263 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2264 /// 2265 static QualType 2266 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2267 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2268 ASTContext &Context, 2269 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2270 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2271 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2272 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2273 2274 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2275 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2276 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2277 2278 QualType CanonFromPointee 2279 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2280 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2281 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2282 2283 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2284 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2285 2286 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2287 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2288 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2289 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2290 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2291 2292 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2293 // already. 2294 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2295 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2296 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2297 } 2298 2299 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2300 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2301 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2302 2303 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2304 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2305 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2306 } 2307 2308 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2309 bool InOverloadResolution, 2310 ASTContext &Context) { 2311 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2312 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2313 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2314 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2315 return !InOverloadResolution; 2316 2317 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2318 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2319 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2320 } 2321 2322 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2323 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2324 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2325 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2326 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2327 /// ConvertedType. 2328 /// 2329 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2330 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2331 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2332 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2333 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2334 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2335 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2336 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2337 /// should result in a warning. 2338 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2339 bool InOverloadResolution, 2340 QualType& ConvertedType, 2341 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2342 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2343 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2344 IncompatibleObjC)) 2345 return true; 2346 2347 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2348 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2349 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2350 ConvertedType = ToType; 2351 return true; 2352 } 2353 2354 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2355 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2356 ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2357 ConvertedType = ToType; 2358 return true; 2359 } 2360 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2361 // pointer type. 2362 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2363 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2364 ConvertedType = ToType; 2365 return true; 2366 } 2367 2368 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2369 // pointer constant. 2370 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2371 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2372 ConvertedType = ToType; 2373 return true; 2374 } 2375 2376 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2377 if (!ToTypePtr) 2378 return false; 2379 2380 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2381 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2382 ConvertedType = ToType; 2383 return true; 2384 } 2385 2386 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2387 // , including objective-c pointers. 2388 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2389 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2390 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2391 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2392 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2393 ToPointeeType, 2394 ToType, Context); 2395 return true; 2396 } 2397 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2398 if (!FromTypePtr) 2399 return false; 2400 2401 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2402 2403 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2404 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2405 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2406 return false; 2407 2408 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2409 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2410 // 4.10p2). 2411 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2412 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2413 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2414 ToPointeeType, 2415 ToType, Context, 2416 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2417 return true; 2418 } 2419 2420 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2421 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2422 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2423 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2424 ToPointeeType, 2425 ToType, Context); 2426 return true; 2427 } 2428 2429 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2430 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2431 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2432 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2433 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2434 ToPointeeType, 2435 ToType, Context); 2436 return true; 2437 } 2438 2439 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2440 // 2441 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2442 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2443 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2444 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2445 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2446 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2447 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2448 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2449 // 2450 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2451 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2452 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2453 ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2454 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2455 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2456 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2457 ToPointeeType, 2458 ToType, Context); 2459 return true; 2460 } 2461 2462 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2463 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2464 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2465 ToPointeeType, 2466 ToType, Context); 2467 return true; 2468 } 2469 2470 return false; 2471 } 2472 2473 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2474 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2475 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2476 2477 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2478 if (TQs == Qs) 2479 return T; 2480 2481 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2482 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2483 2484 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2485 } 2486 2487 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2488 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2489 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2490 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2491 QualType& ConvertedType, 2492 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2493 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 2494 return false; 2495 2496 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2497 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2498 2499 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2500 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2501 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2502 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2503 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2504 2505 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2506 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2507 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2508 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2509 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2510 return false; 2511 2512 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2513 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2514 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2515 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2516 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2517 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2518 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2519 return false; 2520 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2521 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2522 ToType, Context); 2523 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2524 return true; 2525 } 2526 2527 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2528 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2529 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2530 // complain about it. 2531 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2532 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2533 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2534 ToType, Context); 2535 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2536 return true; 2537 } 2538 } 2539 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2540 QualType ToPointeeType; 2541 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2542 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2543 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2544 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2545 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2546 // to a block pointer type. 2547 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2548 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2549 return true; 2550 } 2551 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2552 } 2553 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2554 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2555 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2556 // pointer to any object. 2557 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2558 return true; 2559 } 2560 else 2561 return false; 2562 2563 QualType FromPointeeType; 2564 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2565 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2566 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2567 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2568 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2569 else 2570 return false; 2571 2572 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2573 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2574 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2575 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2576 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2577 // We always complain about this conversion. 2578 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2579 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2580 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2581 return true; 2582 } 2583 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2584 // as in I* to id. 2585 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2586 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2587 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2588 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2589 2590 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2591 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2592 return true; 2593 } 2594 2595 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2596 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2597 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2598 // complain about it). 2599 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2600 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2601 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2602 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2603 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2604 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2605 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2606 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2607 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2608 return false; 2609 2610 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2611 // function types are obviously different. 2612 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2613 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2614 FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals()) 2615 return false; 2616 2617 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2618 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2619 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2620 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2621 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2622 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2623 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2624 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2625 HasObjCConversion = true; 2626 } else { 2627 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2628 return false; 2629 } 2630 2631 // Check argument types. 2632 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2633 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2634 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2635 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2636 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2637 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2638 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2639 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2640 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2641 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2642 HasObjCConversion = true; 2643 } else { 2644 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2645 return false; 2646 } 2647 } 2648 2649 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2650 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2651 // conversion, but complain about it. 2652 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2653 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2654 return true; 2655 } 2656 } 2657 2658 return false; 2659 } 2660 2661 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2662 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2663 /// 2664 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2665 /// 2666 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2667 /// 2668 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2669 /// this conversion. 2670 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2671 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2672 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2673 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2674 return false; 2675 2676 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2677 QualType ToPointee; 2678 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2679 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2680 else 2681 return false; 2682 2683 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2684 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2685 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2686 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2687 return false; 2688 2689 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2690 QualType FromPointee; 2691 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2692 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2693 else 2694 return false; 2695 2696 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2697 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2698 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2699 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2700 return false; 2701 2702 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2703 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2704 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2705 return false; 2706 2707 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2708 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2709 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2710 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2711 2712 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2713 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2714 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2715 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2716 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2717 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2718 IncompatibleObjC)) 2719 return false; 2720 2721 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2722 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2723 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2724 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2725 return true; 2726 } 2727 2728 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2729 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2730 QualType ToPointeeType; 2731 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2732 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2733 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2734 else 2735 return false; 2736 2737 QualType FromPointeeType; 2738 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2739 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2740 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2741 else 2742 return false; 2743 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2744 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2745 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2746 2747 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2748 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2749 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2750 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2751 2752 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2753 return false; 2754 2755 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2756 return true; 2757 2758 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2759 // function types are obviously different. 2760 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2761 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2762 return false; 2763 2764 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2765 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2766 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2767 return false; 2768 2769 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2770 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2771 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2772 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2773 } else { 2774 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2775 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2776 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2777 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2778 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2779 2780 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2781 // OK exact match. 2782 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2783 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2784 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2785 return false; 2786 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2787 } 2788 else 2789 return false; 2790 } 2791 2792 // Check argument types. 2793 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2794 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2795 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2796 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2797 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2798 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2799 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2800 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2801 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2802 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2803 return false; 2804 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2805 } else 2806 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2807 return false; 2808 } 2809 2810 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2811 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2812 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2813 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2814 NewParamInfos)) 2815 return false; 2816 2817 ConvertedType = ToType; 2818 return true; 2819 } 2820 2821 enum { 2822 ft_default, 2823 ft_different_class, 2824 ft_parameter_arity, 2825 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2826 ft_return_type, 2827 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2828 ft_noexcept 2829 }; 2830 2831 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2832 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2833 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2834 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2835 return FPT; 2836 2837 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2838 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2839 2840 return nullptr; 2841 } 2842 2843 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2844 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2845 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2846 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2847 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2848 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2849 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2850 PDiag << ft_default; 2851 return; 2852 } 2853 2854 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2855 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2856 const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2857 *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2858 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2859 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2860 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2861 return; 2862 } 2863 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2864 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2865 } 2866 2867 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2868 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2869 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2870 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2871 2872 // Remove references. 2873 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2874 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2875 2876 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2877 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2878 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2879 PDiag << ft_default; 2880 return; 2881 } 2882 2883 // No extra info for same types. 2884 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2885 PDiag << ft_default; 2886 return; 2887 } 2888 2889 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2890 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2891 2892 // Both types need to be function types. 2893 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2894 PDiag << ft_default; 2895 return; 2896 } 2897 2898 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2899 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2900 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2901 return; 2902 } 2903 2904 // Handle different parameter types. 2905 unsigned ArgPos; 2906 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2907 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2908 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2909 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2910 return; 2911 } 2912 2913 // Handle different return type. 2914 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2915 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2916 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2917 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2918 return; 2919 } 2920 2921 if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) { 2922 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals() 2923 << FromFunction->getMethodQuals(); 2924 return; 2925 } 2926 2927 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2928 // onwards). 2929 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2930 ->isNothrow() != 2931 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2932 ->isNothrow()) { 2933 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2934 return; 2935 } 2936 2937 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2938 PDiag << ft_default; 2939 } 2940 2941 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2942 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2943 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2944 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2945 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2946 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2947 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2948 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2949 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2950 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2951 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2952 // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading 2953 // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces. 2954 QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType()); 2955 QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType()); 2956 2957 if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) { 2958 if (ArgPos) 2959 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2960 return false; 2961 } 2962 } 2963 return true; 2964 } 2965 2966 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2967 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2968 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2969 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2970 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2971 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2972 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2973 CastKind &Kind, 2974 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2975 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2976 bool Diagnose) { 2977 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2978 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2979 2980 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2981 2982 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2983 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2984 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2985 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2986 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 2987 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 2988 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 2989 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 2990 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 2991 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2992 } 2993 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2994 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2995 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 2996 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2997 2998 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2999 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 3000 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 3001 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 3002 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 3003 unsigned AmbigiousID = 0; 3004 if (Diagnose) { 3005 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 3006 AmbigiousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 3007 } 3008 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 3009 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbigiousID, 3010 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 3011 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 3012 return true; 3013 3014 // The conversion was successful. 3015 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 3016 } 3017 3018 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 3019 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 3020 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 3021 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 3022 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 3023 << From->getSourceRange(); 3024 } 3025 } 3026 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 3027 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3028 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 3029 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3030 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 3031 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 3032 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 3033 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 3034 return false; 3035 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3036 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3037 } else { 3038 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3039 } 3040 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3041 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 3042 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 3043 } 3044 3045 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 3046 // reasons. 3047 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 3048 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 3049 3050 return false; 3051 } 3052 3053 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 3054 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 3055 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 3056 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 3057 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 3058 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 3059 QualType ToType, 3060 bool InOverloadResolution, 3061 QualType &ConvertedType) { 3062 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3063 if (!ToTypePtr) 3064 return false; 3065 3066 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 3067 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3068 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 3069 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 3070 ConvertedType = ToType; 3071 return true; 3072 } 3073 3074 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 3075 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3076 if (!FromTypePtr) 3077 return false; 3078 3079 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 3080 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 3081 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3082 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3083 3084 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 3085 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 3086 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 3087 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 3088 return true; 3089 } 3090 3091 return false; 3092 } 3093 3094 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 3095 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 3096 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 3097 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 3098 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 3099 /// otherwise. 3100 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3101 CastKind &Kind, 3102 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 3103 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 3104 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 3105 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3106 if (!FromPtrType) { 3107 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 3108 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3109 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 3110 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 3111 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 3112 return false; 3113 } 3114 3115 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3116 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 3117 "that is not a member pointer."); 3118 3119 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3120 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3121 3122 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3123 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3124 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3125 3126 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3127 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3128 bool DerivationOkay = 3129 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3130 assert(DerivationOkay && 3131 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3132 (void)DerivationOkay; 3133 3134 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3135 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3136 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3137 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3138 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3139 return true; 3140 } 3141 3142 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3143 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3144 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3145 << From->getSourceRange(); 3146 return true; 3147 } 3148 3149 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3150 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3151 Paths.front(), 3152 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3153 3154 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3155 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3156 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3157 return false; 3158 } 3159 3160 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3161 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3162 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3163 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3164 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3165 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3166 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3167 return false; 3168 3169 return true; 3170 } 3171 3172 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification 3173 /// conversion is valid. 3174 /// 3175 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p 3176 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every 3177 /// outer layer is const-qualified. 3178 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3179 bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel, 3180 bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 3181 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3182 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3183 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3184 3185 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3186 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3187 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3188 3189 // Objective-C ARC: 3190 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3191 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) { 3192 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3193 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3194 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3195 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3196 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3197 } else { 3198 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3199 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3200 return false; 3201 } 3202 } 3203 3204 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3205 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3206 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3207 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3208 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3209 } 3210 3211 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3212 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3213 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3214 return false; 3215 3216 // If address spaces mismatch: 3217 // - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a 3218 // superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow 3219 // conversions between overlapping address spaces. 3220 // - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion. 3221 if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() && 3222 (!IsTopLevel || 3223 !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) || 3224 (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals))))) 3225 return false; 3226 3227 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3228 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3229 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() && 3230 !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3231 return false; 3232 3233 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3234 // include const. 3235 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = 3236 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3237 return true; 3238 } 3239 3240 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3241 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3242 /// (C++ 4.4). 3243 /// 3244 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3245 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3246 /// object lifetime. 3247 bool 3248 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3249 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3250 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3251 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3252 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3253 3254 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3255 // qualification conversion. 3256 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3257 return false; 3258 3259 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3260 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3261 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3262 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3263 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3264 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3265 if (!isQualificationConversionStep( 3266 FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer, 3267 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 3268 return false; 3269 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3270 } 3271 3272 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3273 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3274 // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3275 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3276 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3277 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3278 } 3279 3280 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3281 /// atomic type. 3282 /// 3283 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3284 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3285 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3286 bool InOverloadResolution, 3287 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3288 bool CStyle) { 3289 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3290 if (!ToAtomic) 3291 return false; 3292 3293 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3294 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3295 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3296 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3297 return false; 3298 3299 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3300 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3301 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3302 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3303 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3304 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3305 return true; 3306 } 3307 3308 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3309 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3310 QualType Type) { 3311 const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3312 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3313 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3314 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3315 return true; 3316 } 3317 return false; 3318 } 3319 3320 static OverloadingResult 3321 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3322 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3323 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3324 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3325 bool AllowExplicit) { 3326 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3327 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3328 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3329 if (!Info) 3330 continue; 3331 3332 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3333 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor); 3334 if (Usable) { 3335 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3336 // suppress conversions. 3337 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3338 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3339 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3340 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3341 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3342 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3343 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3344 AllowExplicit); 3345 else 3346 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3347 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3348 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3349 } 3350 } 3351 3352 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3353 3354 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3355 switch (auto Result = 3356 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3357 case OR_Deleted: 3358 case OR_Success: { 3359 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3360 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3361 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3362 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3363 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3364 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3365 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3366 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3367 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3368 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3369 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3370 return Result; 3371 } 3372 3373 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3374 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3375 case OR_Ambiguous: 3376 return OR_Ambiguous; 3377 } 3378 3379 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3380 } 3381 3382 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3383 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3384 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3385 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3386 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3387 /// false and User is unspecified. 3388 /// 3389 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3390 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3391 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3392 /// 3393 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3394 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3395 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3396 static OverloadingResult 3397 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3398 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3399 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3400 bool AllowExplicit, 3401 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3402 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3403 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3404 3405 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3406 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3407 3408 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3409 // constructors. 3410 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3411 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3412 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3413 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3414 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3415 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3416 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3417 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3418 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3419 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3420 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3421 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3422 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3423 3424 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3425 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3426 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3427 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3428 3429 Expr **Args = &From; 3430 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3431 bool ListInitializing = false; 3432 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3433 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3434 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3435 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 3436 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3437 return Result; 3438 // Never mind. 3439 CandidateSet.clear( 3440 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3441 3442 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3443 // arguments, not the entire list. 3444 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3445 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3446 ListInitializing = true; 3447 } 3448 3449 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3450 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3451 if (!Info) 3452 continue; 3453 3454 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3455 if (!ListInitializing) 3456 Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor( 3457 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 3458 if (Usable) { 3459 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3460 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3461 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3462 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3463 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3464 // suppress conversions. 3465 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3466 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3467 } 3468 } 3469 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3470 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3471 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3472 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3473 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3474 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3475 else 3476 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3477 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3478 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3479 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3480 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3481 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3482 } 3483 } 3484 } 3485 } 3486 3487 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3488 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3489 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) { 3490 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3491 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType = 3492 From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3493 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3494 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3495 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3496 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3497 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3498 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3499 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3500 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3501 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3502 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3503 3504 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3505 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3506 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3507 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3508 else 3509 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3510 3511 if (ConvTemplate) 3512 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 3513 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3514 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, AllowExplicit); 3515 else 3516 S.AddConversionCandidate( 3517 Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 3518 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, AllowExplicit); 3519 } 3520 } 3521 } 3522 3523 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3524 3525 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3526 switch (auto Result = 3527 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3528 case OR_Success: 3529 case OR_Deleted: 3530 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3531 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3532 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3533 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3534 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3535 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3536 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3537 // the argument of the constructor. 3538 // 3539 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3540 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3541 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3542 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3543 } else { 3544 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3545 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3546 else { 3547 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3548 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3549 } 3550 } 3551 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3552 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3553 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3554 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3555 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3556 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3557 return Result; 3558 } 3559 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3560 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3561 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3562 // 3563 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3564 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3565 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3566 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3567 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3568 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3569 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3570 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3571 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3572 3573 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3574 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3575 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3576 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3577 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3578 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3579 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3580 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3581 // 13.3.3.1). 3582 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3583 return Result; 3584 } 3585 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3586 3587 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3588 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3589 3590 case OR_Ambiguous: 3591 return OR_Ambiguous; 3592 } 3593 3594 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3595 } 3596 3597 bool 3598 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3599 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3600 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3601 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3602 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3603 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3604 CandidateSet, false, false); 3605 3606 if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous || 3607 (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()))) 3608 return false; 3609 3610 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates( 3611 *this, 3612 OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates, 3613 From); 3614 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3615 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3616 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3617 else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty() 3618 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 3619 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3620 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3621 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3622 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3623 } 3624 3625 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 3626 *this, From, Cands); 3627 return true; 3628 } 3629 3630 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3631 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3632 /// is possible. 3633 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3634 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3635 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3636 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3637 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3638 3639 // Objective-C++: 3640 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3641 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3642 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3643 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3644 // to keep code working. 3645 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3646 if (!Conv1) 3647 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3648 3649 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3650 if (!Conv2) 3651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3652 3653 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3654 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3655 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3656 if (Block1 != Block2) 3657 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3658 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3659 } 3660 3661 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3662 } 3663 3664 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3665 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3666 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3667 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3668 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3669 } 3670 3671 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3672 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3673 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3674 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3675 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3676 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3677 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3678 { 3679 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3680 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3681 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3682 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3683 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3684 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3685 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3686 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3687 // 3688 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3689 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3690 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3691 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3692 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3693 3694 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3695 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3696 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3697 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3698 // standard. For example: 3699 // 3700 // int &f(...); // #1 3701 // void f(char*); // #2 3702 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3703 // 3704 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3705 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3706 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3707 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3708 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3709 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3710 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3711 3712 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3713 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3714 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3715 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3716 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3717 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3718 3719 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3720 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3721 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3722 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3723 3724 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3725 // the same kind. 3726 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3727 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3728 3729 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3730 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3731 3732 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3733 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3734 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3735 3736 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3737 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3738 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3739 // if not that, 3740 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3741 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3742 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3743 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3744 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3745 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3746 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3747 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3748 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3749 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3750 } 3751 3752 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3753 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3754 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3755 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3756 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3757 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3758 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3759 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3760 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3761 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3762 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3763 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3764 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3765 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3766 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3767 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3768 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3769 else 3770 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3771 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3772 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3773 } 3774 3775 return Result; 3776 } 3777 3778 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3779 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3780 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3781 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3782 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3783 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3784 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3785 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3786 3787 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3788 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3789 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3790 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3791 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3792 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3793 3794 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3795 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3796 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3797 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3798 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3799 else 3800 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3801 } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3802 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3803 3804 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3805 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3806 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3807 } 3808 3809 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3810 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3811 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3812 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3813 3814 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3815 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3816 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3817 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3818 3819 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3820 } 3821 3822 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3823 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3824 static bool 3825 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3826 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3827 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3828 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3829 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3830 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3831 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3832 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3833 // reference*. 3834 // 3835 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3836 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3837 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3838 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3839 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3840 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3841 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3842 return false; 3843 3844 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3845 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3846 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3847 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3848 } 3849 3850 enum class FixedEnumPromotion { 3851 None, 3852 ToUnderlyingType, 3853 ToPromotedUnderlyingType 3854 }; 3855 3856 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses. 3857 static FixedEnumPromotion 3858 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 3859 3860 if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion) 3861 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3862 3863 QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType(); 3864 if (!FromType->isEnumeralType()) 3865 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3866 3867 EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); 3868 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 3869 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3870 3871 QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 3872 if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType)) 3873 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType; 3874 3875 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType; 3876 } 3877 3878 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3879 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3880 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3881 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3882 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3883 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3884 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3885 { 3886 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3887 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3888 3889 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3890 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3891 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3892 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3893 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3894 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3895 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3896 return CK; 3897 3898 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3899 // defined below), or, if not that, 3900 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3901 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3902 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3903 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3904 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3905 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3906 3907 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3908 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3909 // applies: 3910 3911 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3912 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3913 // that is such a conversion. 3914 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3915 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3916 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3917 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3918 3919 // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3920 // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601. 3921 // 3922 // A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed 3923 // to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted 3924 // underlying type, if the two are different. 3925 FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1); 3926 FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2); 3927 if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && 3928 FEP1 != FEP2) 3929 return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType 3930 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3931 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3932 3933 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3934 // 3935 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3936 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3937 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3938 // of B* to void*. 3939 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3940 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3941 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3942 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3943 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3944 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3945 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3946 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3947 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3948 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3949 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3950 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3951 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3952 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 3953 return DerivedCK; 3954 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3955 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3956 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3957 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3958 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3959 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3960 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3961 3962 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3963 // conversion, if we need to. 3964 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3965 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3966 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3967 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3968 3969 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3970 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3971 3972 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3973 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3974 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3975 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3976 3977 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3978 // other, it is the better one. 3979 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3980 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3981 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 3982 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3983 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 3984 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 3985 FromObjCPtr2); 3986 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 3987 FromObjCPtr1); 3988 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 3989 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3990 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3991 } 3992 } 3993 } 3994 3995 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 3996 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 3997 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 3998 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3999 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 4000 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4001 } 4002 4003 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 4004 // bullet 3). 4005 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 4006 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 4007 return QualCK; 4008 4009 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4010 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 4011 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 4012 // which the references refer are the same type except for 4013 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 4014 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 4015 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 4016 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4017 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4018 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4019 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4020 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4021 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4022 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4023 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4024 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 4025 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 4026 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 4027 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 4028 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 4029 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4030 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4031 } 4032 4033 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 4034 // type for comparison. 4035 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4036 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4037 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4038 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4039 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 4040 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4041 if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 4042 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4043 } 4044 } 4045 4046 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 4047 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 4048 // is between types of the same size. 4049 // For example: 4050 // void f(float); 4051 // void f(int); 4052 // int main { 4053 // long a; 4054 // f(a); 4055 // } 4056 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 4057 // as clang will do in standard mode. 4058 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 4059 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 4060 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 4061 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 4062 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4063 4064 // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion 4065 // For example: 4066 // 4067 // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16))); 4068 // void f(vector float); 4069 // void f(vector signed int); 4070 // int main() { 4071 // __v4sf a; 4072 // f(a); 4073 // } 4074 // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not 4075 // report an ambiguous call error 4076 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion && 4077 SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) { 4078 bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4079 SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4080 bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4081 SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4082 4083 if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion) 4084 return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion 4085 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4086 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4087 } 4088 4089 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4090 } 4091 4092 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4093 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4094 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 4095 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4096 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 4097 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4098 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4099 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 4100 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 4101 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 4102 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 4103 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 4104 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 4105 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 4106 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 4107 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4108 4109 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 4110 // conversion (!) 4111 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4112 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4113 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4114 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4115 assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType()); 4116 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4117 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4118 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4119 4120 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping 4121 // them. 4122 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 4123 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4124 4125 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 4126 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4127 4128 // Objective-C++ ARC: 4129 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 4130 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 4131 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 4132 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 4133 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 4134 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4135 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4136 } 4137 4138 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) { 4139 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 4140 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 4141 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 4142 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 4143 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 4144 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 4145 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 4146 // strict subset of qualifiers. 4147 if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() == 4148 T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime()) 4149 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 4150 // about how the sequences rank. 4151 // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with 4152 // the ARC overload rule. 4153 ; 4154 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 4155 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4156 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4157 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4158 // qualifiers. 4159 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4160 4161 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4162 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 4163 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4164 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 4165 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4166 // qualifiers. 4167 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4168 4169 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4170 } else { 4171 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 4172 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4173 } 4174 4175 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 4176 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4177 break; 4178 } 4179 4180 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 4181 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 4182 switch (Result) { 4183 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 4184 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4185 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4186 break; 4187 4188 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 4189 break; 4190 4191 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 4192 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4193 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4194 break; 4195 } 4196 4197 return Result; 4198 } 4199 4200 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4201 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4202 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4203 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4204 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4205 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4206 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4207 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4208 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4209 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4210 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4211 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4212 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4213 4214 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4215 // conversion, if we need to. 4216 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4217 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4218 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4219 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4220 4221 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4222 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4223 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4224 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4225 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4226 4227 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4228 // 4229 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4230 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4231 // 4232 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4233 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4234 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4235 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4236 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4237 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4238 QualType FromPointee1 = 4239 FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4240 QualType ToPointee1 = 4241 ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4242 QualType FromPointee2 = 4243 FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4244 QualType ToPointee2 = 4245 ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4246 4247 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4248 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4249 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4250 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4251 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4252 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4253 } 4254 4255 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4256 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4257 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4258 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4259 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4260 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4261 } 4262 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4263 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4264 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4265 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4266 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4267 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4268 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4269 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4270 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4271 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4272 4273 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4274 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4275 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4276 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4277 // Objective-C pointer types. 4278 bool FromAssignLeft 4279 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4280 bool FromAssignRight 4281 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4282 bool ToAssignLeft 4283 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4284 bool ToAssignRight 4285 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4286 4287 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4288 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4289 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4290 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4291 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4292 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4293 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4294 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4295 4296 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4297 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4298 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4299 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4300 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4301 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4302 4303 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4304 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4305 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4306 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4307 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4308 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4309 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4310 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4311 4312 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4313 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4314 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4315 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4316 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4317 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4318 4319 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4320 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4321 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4322 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4323 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4324 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4325 // C *. 4326 bool IsFirstSame = 4327 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4328 bool IsSecondSame = 4329 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4330 if (IsFirstSame) { 4331 if (!IsSecondSame) 4332 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4333 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4334 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4335 } 4336 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4337 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4338 } 4339 4340 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4341 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4342 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4343 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4344 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4345 } 4346 } 4347 4348 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4349 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4350 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4351 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4352 const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4353 const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4354 const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4355 const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4356 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4357 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4358 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4359 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4360 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4361 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4362 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4363 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4364 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4365 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4366 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4367 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4368 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4369 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4370 } 4371 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4372 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4373 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4374 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4375 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4376 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4377 } 4378 } 4379 4380 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4381 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4382 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4383 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4384 // reference of type A&, 4385 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4386 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4387 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4388 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4389 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4390 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4391 } 4392 4393 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4394 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4395 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4396 // reference of type A&, 4397 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4398 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4399 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4400 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4401 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4402 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4403 } 4404 } 4405 4406 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4407 } 4408 4409 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4410 /// C++ class. 4411 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4412 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4413 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4414 4415 return true; 4416 } 4417 4418 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 4419 if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 4420 return T; 4421 4422 Qualifiers Q; 4423 T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q); 4424 Q.removeUnaligned(); 4425 return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q); 4426 } 4427 4428 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4429 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible, 4430 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4431 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4432 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4433 /// type being initialized. 4434 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4435 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4436 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4437 ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) { 4438 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4439 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4440 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4441 4442 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4443 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4444 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4445 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4446 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4447 4448 ReferenceConversions ConvTmp; 4449 ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp; 4450 Conv = ReferenceConversions(); 4451 4452 // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4453 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4454 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or 4455 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4456 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if 4457 // a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type 4458 // "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence. 4459 4460 // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base 4461 // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions. 4462 // (Qualification conversions are checked last.) 4463 QualType ConvertedT2; 4464 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4465 // Nothing to do. 4466 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4467 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4468 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4469 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase; 4470 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4471 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4472 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4473 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC; 4474 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4475 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) { 4476 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function; 4477 // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them. 4478 return Ref_Compatible; 4479 } 4480 bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0; 4481 4482 // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are 4483 // similar at the same time. 4484 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 4485 bool TopLevel = true; 4486 do { 4487 if (T1 == T2) 4488 break; 4489 4490 // We will need a qualification conversion. 4491 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification; 4492 4493 // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other 4494 // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in 4495 // overload resolution. 4496 if (!TopLevel) 4497 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification; 4498 4499 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4500 T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1); 4501 T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2); 4502 4503 // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible, 4504 // but are still be reference-related if they're similar. 4505 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4506 if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel, 4507 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 4508 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 4509 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2)) 4510 ? Ref_Related 4511 : Ref_Incompatible; 4512 4513 // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first? 4514 if (ObjCLifetimeConversion) 4515 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime; 4516 4517 TopLevel = false; 4518 } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)); 4519 4520 // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the 4521 // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how 4522 // to convert the referent. 4523 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4524 ? Ref_Compatible 4525 : Ref_Incompatible; 4526 } 4527 4528 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4529 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4530 static bool 4531 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4532 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4533 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4534 bool AllowExplicit) { 4535 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4536 auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4537 4538 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4539 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4540 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4541 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4542 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4543 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4544 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4545 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4546 4547 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4548 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4549 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4550 if (ConvTemplate) 4551 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4552 else 4553 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4554 4555 if (AllowRvalues) { 4556 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4557 // functions that return lvalues. 4558 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4559 const ReferenceType *RefType 4560 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4561 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4562 continue; 4563 } 4564 4565 if (!ConvTemplate && 4566 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4567 DeclLoc, 4568 Conv->getConversionType() 4569 .getNonReferenceType() 4570 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4571 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) == 4572 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4573 continue; 4574 } else { 4575 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4576 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4577 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4578 4579 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4580 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4581 if (!RefType || 4582 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4583 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4584 continue; 4585 } 4586 4587 if (ConvTemplate) 4588 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 4589 ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4590 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4591 else 4592 S.AddConversionCandidate( 4593 Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4594 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4595 } 4596 4597 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4598 4599 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4600 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4601 case OR_Success: 4602 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4603 // 4604 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4605 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4606 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4607 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4608 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4609 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4610 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4611 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4612 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4613 return false; 4614 4615 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4616 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4617 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4618 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4619 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4620 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4621 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4622 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4623 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4624 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4625 return true; 4626 4627 case OR_Ambiguous: 4628 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4629 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4630 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4631 if (Cand->Best) 4632 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4633 return true; 4634 4635 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4636 case OR_Deleted: 4637 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4638 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4639 return false; 4640 } 4641 4642 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4643 } 4644 4645 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4646 /// initialization. 4647 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4648 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4649 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4650 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4651 bool AllowExplicit) { 4652 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4653 4654 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4655 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4656 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4657 4658 QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4659 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4660 4661 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4662 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4663 // type of the resulting function. 4664 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4665 DeclAccessPair Found; 4666 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4667 false, Found)) 4668 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4669 } 4670 4671 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4672 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4673 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4674 4675 Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv; 4676 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 4677 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv); 4678 4679 auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) { 4680 ICS.setStandard(); 4681 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4682 // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should 4683 // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings. 4684 ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase) 4685 ? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4686 : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC) 4687 ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4688 : ICK_Identity; 4689 // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank 4690 // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification 4691 // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion. 4692 ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv & 4693 Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification) 4694 ? ICK_Qualification 4695 : ICK_Identity; 4696 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4697 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4698 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4699 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4700 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4701 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly; 4702 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4703 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4704 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4705 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4706 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = 4707 (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0; 4708 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4709 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4710 }; 4711 4712 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4713 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4714 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4715 4716 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4717 if (!isRValRef) { 4718 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4719 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4720 // 4721 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4722 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4723 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4724 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4725 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4726 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4727 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4728 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4729 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4730 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true); 4731 4732 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4733 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4734 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4735 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4736 return ICS; 4737 } 4738 4739 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4740 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4741 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4742 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4743 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4744 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4745 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4746 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4747 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4748 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4749 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4750 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4751 AllowExplicit)) 4752 return ICS; 4753 } 4754 } 4755 4756 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4757 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4758 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4759 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4760 return ICS; 4761 4762 // -- If the initializer expression 4763 // 4764 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4765 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4766 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4767 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4768 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && 4769 (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4770 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4771 // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4772 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4773 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4774 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4775 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4776 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4777 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType())); 4778 return ICS; 4779 } 4780 4781 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4782 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4783 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4784 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4785 // "cv3 T3", 4786 // 4787 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4788 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4789 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4790 // class subobject). 4791 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4792 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4793 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4794 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4795 AllowExplicit)) { 4796 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4797 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4798 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4799 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4800 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4801 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4802 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4803 4804 return ICS; 4805 } 4806 4807 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4808 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4809 return ICS; 4810 4811 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4812 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4813 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4814 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4815 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4816 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4817 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4818 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4819 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4820 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4821 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4822 // initialization fails. 4823 // 4824 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4825 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4826 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4827 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4828 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4829 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4830 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4831 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4832 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4833 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4834 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4835 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4836 return ICS; 4837 } 4838 4839 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4840 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4841 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4842 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4843 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4844 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4845 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4846 return ICS; 4847 4848 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4849 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4850 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4851 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4852 return ICS; 4853 4854 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4855 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4856 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4857 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4858 // underlying type of the reference according to 4859 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4860 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4861 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4862 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4863 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4864 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4865 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4866 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4867 /*CStyle=*/false, 4868 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4869 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4870 4871 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4872 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4873 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4874 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4875 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4876 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4877 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4878 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4879 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4880 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4881 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4882 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4883 4884 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4885 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4886 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4887 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4888 // lvalue. 4889 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4890 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4891 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4892 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4893 // reference to an rvalue! 4894 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4895 return ICS; 4896 } 4897 4898 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4899 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4900 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4901 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4902 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4903 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4904 } 4905 4906 return ICS; 4907 } 4908 4909 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4910 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4911 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4912 bool InOverloadResolution, 4913 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4914 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4915 4916 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4917 /// initializer list From. 4918 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4919 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4920 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4921 bool InOverloadResolution, 4922 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4923 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4924 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4925 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4926 4927 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4928 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4929 4930 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4931 // initialized from init lists. 4932 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType)) 4933 return Result; 4934 4935 // Per DR1467: 4936 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 4937 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 4938 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 4939 // to the parameter type. 4940 // 4941 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 4942 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 4943 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 4944 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 4945 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4946 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 4947 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 4948 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 4949 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType)) 4950 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4951 SuppressUserConversions, 4952 InOverloadResolution, 4953 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4954 } 4955 // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type, 4956 // initializer is a string literal. 4957 if (ToType->isArrayType()) { 4958 InitializedEntity Entity = 4959 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4960 /*Consumed=*/false); 4961 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4962 Result.setStandard(); 4963 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4964 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4965 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4966 return Result; 4967 } 4968 } 4969 } 4970 4971 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 4972 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 4973 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 4974 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 4975 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 4976 // element of the list to X. 4977 // 4978 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 4979 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 4980 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 4981 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 4982 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 4983 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 4984 // 4985 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 4986 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 4987 QualType X; 4988 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 4989 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 4990 else 4991 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 4992 if (!X.isNull()) { 4993 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 4994 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 4995 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4996 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 4997 InOverloadResolution, 4998 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4999 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 5000 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5001 Result = ICS; 5002 break; 5003 } 5004 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 5005 if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 5006 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) == 5007 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 5008 Result = ICS; 5009 } 5010 5011 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 5012 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 5013 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 5014 Result.setStandard(); 5015 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5016 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5017 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5018 } 5019 5020 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 5021 return Result; 5022 } 5023 5024 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 5025 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 5026 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 5027 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 5028 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 5029 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 5030 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5031 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5032 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 5033 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5034 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 5035 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 5036 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5037 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5038 } 5039 5040 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 5041 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 5042 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 5043 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 5044 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5045 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5046 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 5047 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 5048 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 5049 InitializedEntity Entity = 5050 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5051 /*Consumed=*/false); 5052 if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity, 5053 From)) { 5054 Result.setUserDefined(); 5055 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5056 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 5057 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 5058 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 5059 5060 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5061 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 5062 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5063 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 5064 } 5065 return Result; 5066 } 5067 5068 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 5069 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 5070 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 5071 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 5072 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 5073 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 5074 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 5075 5076 QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5077 5078 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 5079 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 5080 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5081 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 5082 5083 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 5084 5085 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 5086 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 5087 // type of the resulting function. 5088 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5089 DeclAccessPair Found; 5090 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 5091 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 5092 T2 = Fn->getType(); 5093 } 5094 5095 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 5096 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 5097 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2); 5098 5099 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 5100 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5101 SuppressUserConversions, 5102 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5103 } 5104 } 5105 5106 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 5107 // initializer list. 5108 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 5109 InOverloadResolution, 5110 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5111 if (Result.isFailure()) 5112 return Result; 5113 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 5114 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 5115 5116 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 5117 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 5118 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 5119 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 5120 Result.UserDefined.After; 5121 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 5122 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 5123 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 5124 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5125 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 5126 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 5127 } else 5128 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 5129 From, ToType); 5130 return Result; 5131 } 5132 5133 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 5134 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 5135 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 5136 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 5137 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 5138 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 5139 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 5140 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 5141 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 5142 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5143 SuppressUserConversions, 5144 InOverloadResolution, 5145 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5146 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 5147 // sequence is the identity conversion. 5148 else if (NumInits == 0) { 5149 Result.setStandard(); 5150 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5151 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5152 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5153 } 5154 return Result; 5155 } 5156 5157 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 5158 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 5159 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 5160 return Result; 5161 } 5162 5163 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 5164 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 5165 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 5166 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 5167 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 5168 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 5169 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5170 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5171 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5172 bool InOverloadResolution, 5173 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5174 bool AllowExplicit) { 5175 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 5176 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5177 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5178 5179 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 5180 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 5181 /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5182 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit); 5183 5184 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 5185 SuppressUserConversions, 5186 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 5187 InOverloadResolution, 5188 /*CStyle=*/false, 5189 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5190 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5191 } 5192 5193 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5194 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5195 Sema &S, 5196 SourceLocation Loc, 5197 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5198 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5199 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5200 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5201 5202 return !ICS.isBad(); 5203 } 5204 5205 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5206 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5207 /// expression @p From. 5208 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5209 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5210 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5211 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5212 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5213 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5214 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5215 // const volatile object. 5216 Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers(); 5217 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) { 5218 Quals.addConst(); 5219 Quals.addVolatile(); 5220 } 5221 5222 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5223 5224 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5225 // to exit early. 5226 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5227 5228 // We need to have an object of class type. 5229 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5230 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5231 5232 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5233 // better have an lvalue. 5234 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5235 } 5236 5237 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5238 5239 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5240 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5241 // parameter is 5242 // 5243 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5244 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5245 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5246 // ref-qualifier 5247 // 5248 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5249 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5250 // 5251 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5252 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5253 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5254 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5255 // non-constant references. 5256 5257 // First check the qualifiers. 5258 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5259 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5260 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5261 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5262 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5263 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5264 return ICS; 5265 } 5266 5267 if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) { 5268 Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers(); 5269 Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers(); 5270 if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) { 5271 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5272 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5273 return ICS; 5274 } 5275 } 5276 5277 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5278 // affects the conversion rank. 5279 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5280 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5281 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5282 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5283 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5284 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5285 else { 5286 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5287 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5288 return ICS; 5289 } 5290 5291 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5292 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5293 case RQ_None: 5294 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5295 break; 5296 5297 case RQ_LValue: 5298 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) { 5299 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5300 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5301 ImplicitParamType); 5302 return ICS; 5303 } 5304 break; 5305 5306 case RQ_RValue: 5307 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5308 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5309 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5310 ImplicitParamType); 5311 return ICS; 5312 } 5313 break; 5314 } 5315 5316 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5317 ICS.setStandard(); 5318 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5319 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5320 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5321 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5322 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5323 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5324 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5325 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5326 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5327 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5328 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5329 return ICS; 5330 } 5331 5332 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5333 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5334 /// expression. 5335 ExprResult 5336 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5337 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5338 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5339 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5340 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5341 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5342 Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5343 5344 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5345 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5346 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5347 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 5348 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5349 } else { 5350 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5351 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5352 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5353 5354 // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary. 5355 if (From->isRValue()) { 5356 From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From, 5357 Method->getRefQualifier() != 5358 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue); 5359 } 5360 } 5361 5362 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5363 // the actual argument initialization. 5364 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5365 *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5366 Method->getParent()); 5367 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5368 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5369 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5370 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5371 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5372 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5373 if (CVR) { 5374 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5375 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5376 << From->getSourceRange(); 5377 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5378 << Method->getDeclName(); 5379 return ExprError(); 5380 } 5381 break; 5382 } 5383 5384 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5385 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5386 bool IsRValueQualified = 5387 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5388 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5389 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5390 << IsRValueQualified; 5391 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5392 << Method->getDeclName(); 5393 return ExprError(); 5394 } 5395 5396 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5397 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5398 break; 5399 } 5400 5401 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5402 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType 5403 << From->getSourceRange(); 5404 } 5405 5406 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5407 ExprResult FromRes = 5408 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5409 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5410 return ExprError(); 5411 From = FromRes.get(); 5412 } 5413 5414 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) { 5415 CastKind CK; 5416 QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType(); 5417 LangAS DestAS = 5418 PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace(); 5419 if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS) 5420 CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5421 else 5422 CK = CK_NoOp; 5423 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get(); 5424 } 5425 return From; 5426 } 5427 5428 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5429 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5430 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5431 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5432 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5433 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5434 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5435 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5436 /*CStyle=*/false, 5437 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5438 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5439 } 5440 5441 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5442 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5443 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5444 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5445 return ExprError(); 5446 5447 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5448 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5449 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5450 5451 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5452 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5453 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5454 return ExprError(); 5455 } 5456 5457 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5458 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5459 /// is acceptable. 5460 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5461 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5462 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5463 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5464 // conversions are fine. 5465 switch (SCS.Second) { 5466 case ICK_Identity: 5467 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5468 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5469 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5470 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5471 return true; 5472 5473 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5474 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5475 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5476 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5477 // 5478 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5479 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5480 // (non-conforming) extension. 5481 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5482 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5483 5484 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5485 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5486 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5487 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5488 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5489 5490 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5491 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5492 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5493 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5494 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5495 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5496 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5497 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5498 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5499 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5500 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5501 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5502 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5503 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5504 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5505 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5506 return false; 5507 5508 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5509 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5510 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5511 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5512 5513 case ICK_Qualification: 5514 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5515 5516 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5517 break; 5518 } 5519 5520 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5521 } 5522 5523 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5524 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5525 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5526 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5527 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5528 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5529 bool RequireInt) { 5530 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5531 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5532 5533 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5534 return ExprError(); 5535 5536 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5537 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5538 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5539 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5540 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5541 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5542 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5543 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5544 // bool. 5545 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5546 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool 5547 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5548 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5549 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5550 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5551 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5552 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5553 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5554 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5555 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5556 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5557 break; 5558 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5559 // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence 5560 // must be trivial. 5561 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5562 break; 5563 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5564 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5565 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5566 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5567 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5568 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5569 return ExprError(); 5570 5571 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5572 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5573 } 5574 5575 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5576 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5577 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5578 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5579 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5580 } 5581 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5582 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5583 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5584 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5585 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5586 } 5587 5588 ExprResult Result = 5589 S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5590 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5591 return Result; 5592 5593 // C++2a [intro.execution]p5: 5594 // A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...] 5595 Result = 5596 S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(), 5597 /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true); 5598 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5599 return Result; 5600 5601 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5602 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5603 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5604 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5605 PreNarrowingType)) { 5606 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5607 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5608 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5609 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5610 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5611 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5612 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5613 break; 5614 5615 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5616 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5617 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1 5618 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5619 break; 5620 5621 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5622 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5623 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T; 5624 break; 5625 } 5626 5627 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5628 Value = APValue(); 5629 return Result; 5630 } 5631 5632 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5633 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5634 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5635 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5636 Expr::ConstExprUsage Usage = CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg 5637 ? Expr::EvaluateForMangling 5638 : Expr::EvaluateForCodeGen; 5639 5640 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, Usage, S.Context) || 5641 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5642 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5643 // the AST. 5644 Result = ExprError(); 5645 } else { 5646 Value = Eval.Val; 5647 5648 if (Notes.empty()) { 5649 // It's a constant expression. 5650 return ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value); 5651 } 5652 } 5653 5654 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5655 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5656 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 5657 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5658 else { 5659 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5660 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5661 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5662 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5663 } 5664 return ExprError(); 5665 } 5666 5667 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5668 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) { 5669 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false); 5670 } 5671 5672 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5673 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5674 CCEKind CCE) { 5675 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5676 5677 APValue V; 5678 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true); 5679 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5680 Value = V.getInt(); 5681 return R; 5682 } 5683 5684 5685 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5686 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5687 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5688 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5689 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5690 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5691 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5692 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5693 } 5694 } 5695 5696 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5697 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5698 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5699 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5700 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5701 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5702 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5703 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5704 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5705 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5706 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5707 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5708 /*CStyle=*/false, 5709 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5710 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5711 5712 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5713 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5714 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5715 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5716 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5717 break; 5718 5719 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5720 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5721 break; 5722 5723 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5724 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5725 break; 5726 } 5727 5728 return ICS; 5729 } 5730 5731 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5732 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5733 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5734 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5735 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5736 return ExprError(); 5737 5738 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5739 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5740 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5741 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5742 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5743 return ExprResult(); 5744 } 5745 5746 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5747 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5748 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5749 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5750 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5751 } 5752 5753 static ExprResult 5754 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5755 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5756 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5757 5758 if (Converter.Suppress) 5759 return ExprError(); 5760 5761 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5762 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5763 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5764 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5765 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5766 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5767 } 5768 return From; 5769 } 5770 5771 static bool 5772 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5773 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5774 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5775 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5776 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5777 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5778 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5779 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5780 5781 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5782 // conversion; use it. 5783 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5784 std::string TypeStr; 5785 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5786 5787 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5788 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(), 5789 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5790 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5791 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")"); 5792 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5793 5794 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5795 // explicit conversion function. 5796 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5797 return true; 5798 5799 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5800 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5801 HadMultipleCandidates); 5802 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5803 return true; 5804 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5805 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5806 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5807 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5808 } 5809 return false; 5810 } 5811 5812 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5813 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5814 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5815 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5816 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5817 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5818 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5819 5820 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5821 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5822 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5823 return true; 5824 5825 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5826 << From->getSourceRange(); 5827 } 5828 5829 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5830 HadMultipleCandidates); 5831 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5832 return true; 5833 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5834 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5835 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5836 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5837 return false; 5838 } 5839 5840 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5841 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5842 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5843 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5844 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5845 << From->getSourceRange(); 5846 5847 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5848 } 5849 5850 static void 5851 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5852 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5853 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5854 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5855 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5856 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5857 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5858 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5859 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5860 5861 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5862 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5863 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5864 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5865 else 5866 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5867 5868 if (ConvTemplate) 5869 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 5870 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 5871 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 5872 else 5873 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 5874 ToType, CandidateSet, 5875 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, 5876 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 5877 } 5878 } 5879 5880 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 5881 /// by the given converter. 5882 /// 5883 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 5884 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 5885 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 5886 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 5887 /// one target type. 5888 /// 5889 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 5890 /// conversion. 5891 /// 5892 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 5893 /// 5894 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 5895 /// 5896 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 5897 /// successful. 5898 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 5899 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5900 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 5901 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 5902 return From; 5903 5904 // Process placeholders immediately. 5905 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 5906 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 5907 if (result.isInvalid()) 5908 return result; 5909 From = result.get(); 5910 } 5911 5912 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 5913 QualType T = From->getType(); 5914 if (Converter.match(T)) 5915 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5916 5917 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 5918 5919 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 5920 // type. 5921 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 5922 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5923 if (!Converter.Suppress) 5924 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5925 return From; 5926 } 5927 5928 // We must have a complete class type. 5929 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 5930 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 5931 Expr *From; 5932 5933 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 5934 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 5935 5936 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 5937 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5938 } 5939 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 5940 5941 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 5942 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 5943 return From; 5944 5945 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 5946 UnresolvedSet<4> 5947 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 5948 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 5949 const auto &Conversions = 5950 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 5951 5952 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 5953 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 5954 5955 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 5956 QualType ToType; 5957 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 5958 5959 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 5960 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5961 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5962 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 5963 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5964 if (ConvTemplate) { 5965 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 5966 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5967 else 5968 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 5969 } else 5970 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5971 5972 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 5973 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 5974 "viable in C++1y"); 5975 5976 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5977 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 5978 5979 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 5980 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 5981 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 5982 if (!ConvTemplate) 5983 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5984 } else { 5985 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5986 if (ToType.isNull()) 5987 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 5988 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 5989 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 5990 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 5991 } 5992 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5993 } 5994 } 5995 } 5996 5997 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5998 // C++1y [conv]p6: 5999 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 6000 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 6001 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 6002 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 6003 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 6004 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 6005 // exactly one such T. 6006 6007 // If no unique T is found: 6008 if (ToType.isNull()) { 6009 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6010 HadMultipleCandidates, 6011 ExplicitConversions)) 6012 return ExprError(); 6013 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6014 } 6015 6016 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 6017 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 6018 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6019 ViableConversions); 6020 6021 // If one unique T is found: 6022 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 6023 // potentially viable conversions. 6024 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 6025 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 6026 CandidateSet); 6027 6028 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 6029 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 6030 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 6031 case OR_Success: { 6032 // Apply this conversion. 6033 DeclAccessPair Found = 6034 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 6035 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6036 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6037 return ExprError(); 6038 break; 6039 } 6040 case OR_Ambiguous: 6041 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6042 ViableConversions); 6043 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 6044 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6045 HadMultipleCandidates, 6046 ExplicitConversions)) 6047 return ExprError(); 6048 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6049 case OR_Deleted: 6050 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6051 break; 6052 } 6053 } else { 6054 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 6055 case 0: { 6056 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6057 HadMultipleCandidates, 6058 ExplicitConversions)) 6059 return ExprError(); 6060 6061 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6062 break; 6063 } 6064 case 1: { 6065 // Apply this conversion. 6066 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 6067 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6068 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6069 return ExprError(); 6070 break; 6071 } 6072 default: 6073 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6074 ViableConversions); 6075 } 6076 } 6077 6078 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6079 } 6080 6081 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 6082 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 6083 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 6084 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 6085 /// enumeration types. 6086 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 6087 FunctionDecl *Fn, 6088 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 6089 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6090 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 6091 6092 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 6093 return true; 6094 6095 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 6096 return true; 6097 6098 const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6099 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 6100 return false; 6101 6102 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 6103 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 6104 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 6105 return true; 6106 } 6107 6108 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 6109 return false; 6110 6111 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 6112 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 6113 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 6114 return true; 6115 } 6116 6117 return false; 6118 } 6119 6120 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 6121 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 6122 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 6123 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 6124 /// 6125 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 6126 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 6127 /// code completion. 6128 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate( 6129 FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6130 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6131 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6132 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6133 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6134 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6135 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6136 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6137 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6138 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 6139 6140 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6141 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 6142 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 6143 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 6144 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 6145 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 6146 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 6147 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 6148 // is irrelevant. 6149 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 6150 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 6151 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6152 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO); 6153 return; 6154 } 6155 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 6156 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 6157 } 6158 6159 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO)) 6160 return; 6161 6162 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 6163 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 6164 // overload resolution. 6165 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 6166 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 6167 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 6168 return; 6169 6170 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6171 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6172 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6173 6174 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6175 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 6176 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 6177 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 6178 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 6179 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 6180 // candidate functions. 6181 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 6182 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 6183 return; 6184 6185 // Add this candidate 6186 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6187 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 6188 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6189 Candidate.Function = Function; 6190 Candidate.Viable = true; 6191 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6192 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO); 6193 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6194 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6195 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6196 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6197 6198 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 6199 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 6200 // to them in diagnostics. 6201 if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) { 6202 Candidate.Viable = false; 6203 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6204 return; 6205 } 6206 6207 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6208 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6209 Candidate.Viable = false; 6210 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6211 return; 6212 } 6213 6214 if (Constructor) { 6215 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 6216 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 6217 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 6218 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 6219 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 6220 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 6221 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(), 6222 ClassType))) { 6223 Candidate.Viable = false; 6224 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 6225 return; 6226 } 6227 6228 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 6229 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 6230 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 6231 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 6232 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 6233 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 6234 // to C. 6235 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6236 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6237 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6238 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6239 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6240 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6241 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6242 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6243 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6244 Candidate.Viable = false; 6245 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6246 return; 6247 } 6248 } 6249 6250 // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the 6251 // destination address space. 6252 if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf( 6253 Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(), 6254 CandidateSet.getDestAS())) { 6255 Candidate.Viable = false; 6256 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch; 6257 } 6258 } 6259 6260 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6261 6262 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6263 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6264 // list (8.3.5). 6265 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6266 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6267 Candidate.Viable = false; 6268 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6269 return; 6270 } 6271 6272 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6273 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6274 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6275 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6276 // exactly m parameters. 6277 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6278 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6279 // Not enough arguments. 6280 Candidate.Viable = false; 6281 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6282 return; 6283 } 6284 6285 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6286 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6287 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6288 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6289 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6290 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6291 // the class. 6292 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6293 Candidate.Viable = false; 6294 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6295 return; 6296 } 6297 6298 if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6299 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6300 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) || 6301 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6302 Candidate.Viable = false; 6303 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6304 return; 6305 } 6306 } 6307 6308 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6309 // arguments. 6310 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6311 unsigned ConvIdx = 6312 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx; 6313 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6314 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6315 // template argument deduction. 6316 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6317 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6318 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6319 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6320 // parameter of F. 6321 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6322 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 6323 *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions, 6324 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6325 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6326 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions); 6327 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6328 Candidate.Viable = false; 6329 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6330 return; 6331 } 6332 } else { 6333 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6334 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6335 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6336 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6337 } 6338 } 6339 6340 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) { 6341 Candidate.Viable = false; 6342 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6343 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6344 return; 6345 } 6346 6347 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6348 Candidate.Viable = false; 6349 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6350 return; 6351 } 6352 } 6353 6354 ObjCMethodDecl * 6355 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6356 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6357 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6358 return nullptr; 6359 6360 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6361 bool Match = true; 6362 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6363 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6364 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6365 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6366 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6367 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6368 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6369 continue; 6370 6371 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6372 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6373 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6374 Match = false; 6375 break; 6376 } 6377 6378 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6379 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6380 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6381 6382 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6383 // a consumed argument. 6384 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6385 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6386 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6387 6388 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6389 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6390 Match = false; 6391 break; 6392 } 6393 6394 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6395 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6396 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6397 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6398 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6399 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6400 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6401 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6402 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6403 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6404 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6405 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6406 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6407 Match = false; 6408 break; 6409 } 6410 } 6411 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6412 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6413 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6414 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6415 Match = false; 6416 break; 6417 } 6418 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6419 nullptr); 6420 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6421 Match = false; 6422 break; 6423 } 6424 } 6425 } else { 6426 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6427 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6428 Match = false; 6429 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6430 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6431 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6432 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6433 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6434 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6435 return Methods[b]; 6436 } 6437 } 6438 } 6439 6440 if (Match) 6441 return Method; 6442 } 6443 return nullptr; 6444 } 6445 6446 static bool 6447 convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, 6448 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, 6449 bool MissingImplicitThis, Expr *&ConvertedThis, 6450 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6451 if (ThisArg) { 6452 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6453 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6454 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6455 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6456 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6457 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6458 if (R.isInvalid()) 6459 return false; 6460 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6461 } else { 6462 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6463 (void)MD; 6464 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6465 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6466 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6467 } 6468 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6469 } 6470 6471 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6472 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6473 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6474 6475 // Convert the arguments. 6476 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6477 ExprResult R; 6478 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6479 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6480 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6481 6482 if (R.isInvalid()) 6483 return false; 6484 6485 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6486 } 6487 6488 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6489 return false; 6490 6491 // Push default arguments if needed. 6492 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6493 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6494 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6495 Expr *DefArg = P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 6496 ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 6497 : P->getDefaultArg(); 6498 // This can only happen in code completion, i.e. when PartialOverloading 6499 // is true. 6500 if (!DefArg) 6501 return false; 6502 ExprResult R = 6503 S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6504 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(i)), 6505 SourceLocation(), DefArg); 6506 if (R.isInvalid()) 6507 return false; 6508 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6509 } 6510 6511 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6512 return false; 6513 } 6514 return true; 6515 } 6516 6517 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6518 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6519 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6520 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6521 return nullptr; 6522 6523 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6524 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6525 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6526 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6527 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6528 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, Args, Trap, 6529 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6530 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6531 6532 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6533 APValue Result; 6534 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6535 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6536 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 6537 !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6538 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6539 return EIA; 6540 6541 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6542 return EIA; 6543 } 6544 return nullptr; 6545 } 6546 6547 template <typename CheckFn> 6548 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6549 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6550 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6551 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6552 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6553 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6554 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6555 } 6556 6557 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6558 if (Attrs.empty()) 6559 return false; 6560 6561 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6562 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6563 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6564 6565 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6566 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6567 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6568 IsSuccessful); 6569 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6570 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6571 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6572 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6573 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6574 return true; 6575 } 6576 6577 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6578 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6579 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6580 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6581 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6582 } 6583 6584 return false; 6585 } 6586 6587 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6588 const Expr *ThisArg, 6589 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6590 SourceLocation Loc) { 6591 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6592 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6593 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6594 APValue Result; 6595 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6596 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6597 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6598 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6599 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6600 return false; 6601 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6602 }); 6603 } 6604 6605 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6606 SourceLocation Loc) { 6607 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6608 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6609 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6610 bool Result; 6611 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6612 Result; 6613 }); 6614 } 6615 6616 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6617 /// the overload candidate set. 6618 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6619 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6620 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6621 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6622 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6623 bool PartialOverloading, 6624 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6625 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6626 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6627 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6628 6629 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6630 FunctionDecl *FD = 6631 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6632 6633 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6634 QualType ObjectType; 6635 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6636 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6637 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6638 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6639 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6640 // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we 6641 // always classify them as l-values. 6642 if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType()) 6643 ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 6644 else 6645 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6646 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6647 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6648 } 6649 if (FunTmpl) { 6650 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6651 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6652 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6653 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6654 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6655 PartialOverloading); 6656 } else { 6657 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6658 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6659 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6660 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6661 } 6662 } else { 6663 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6664 6665 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6666 // static method as non-static. 6667 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6668 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6669 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6670 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6671 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6672 } 6673 if (FunTmpl) { 6674 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6675 ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6676 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6677 PartialOverloading); 6678 } else { 6679 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6680 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6681 } 6682 } 6683 } 6684 } 6685 6686 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6687 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6688 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, 6689 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6690 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6691 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6692 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6693 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6694 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6695 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6696 6697 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6698 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6699 6700 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6701 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6702 "Expected a member function template"); 6703 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6704 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6705 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6706 SuppressUserConversions, false, PO); 6707 } else { 6708 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6709 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6710 SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO); 6711 } 6712 } 6713 6714 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6715 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6716 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6717 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6718 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6719 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6720 /// operators. 6721 void 6722 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6723 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6724 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6725 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6726 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6727 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6728 bool PartialOverloading, 6729 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6730 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6731 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6732 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6733 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6734 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6735 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6736 6737 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO)) 6738 return; 6739 6740 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6741 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6742 // ignored by overload resolution. 6743 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6744 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6745 return; 6746 6747 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6748 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6749 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6750 6751 // Add this candidate 6752 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6753 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6754 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6755 Candidate.Function = Method; 6756 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6757 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO); 6758 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6759 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6760 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6761 6762 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6763 6764 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6765 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6766 // list (8.3.5). 6767 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6768 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6769 Candidate.Viable = false; 6770 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6771 return; 6772 } 6773 6774 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6775 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6776 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6777 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6778 // exactly m parameters. 6779 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6780 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6781 // Not enough arguments. 6782 Candidate.Viable = false; 6783 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6784 return; 6785 } 6786 6787 Candidate.Viable = true; 6788 6789 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6790 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6791 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6792 else { 6793 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 6794 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6795 // parameter. 6796 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6797 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6798 Method, ActingContext); 6799 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6800 Candidate.Viable = false; 6801 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6802 return; 6803 } 6804 } 6805 6806 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6807 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6808 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6809 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6810 Candidate.Viable = false; 6811 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6812 return; 6813 } 6814 6815 if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6816 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6817 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) || 6818 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6819 Candidate.Viable = false; 6820 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6821 return; 6822 } 6823 } 6824 6825 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6826 // arguments. 6827 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6828 unsigned ConvIdx = 6829 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1); 6830 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6831 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6832 // template argument deduction. 6833 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6834 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6835 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6836 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6837 // parameter of F. 6838 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6839 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] 6840 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6841 SuppressUserConversions, 6842 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6843 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6844 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6845 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6846 Candidate.Viable = false; 6847 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6848 return; 6849 } 6850 } else { 6851 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6852 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6853 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6854 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6855 } 6856 } 6857 6858 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 6859 Candidate.Viable = false; 6860 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6861 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6862 return; 6863 } 6864 6865 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6866 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6867 Candidate.Viable = false; 6868 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6869 } 6870 } 6871 6872 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 6873 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 6874 /// function template specialization. 6875 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6876 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6877 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6878 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, 6879 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6880 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6881 bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6882 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO)) 6883 return; 6884 6885 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6886 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6887 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6888 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6889 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6890 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6891 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6892 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6893 // functions. 6894 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6895 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6896 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6897 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6898 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6899 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6900 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 6901 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6902 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 6903 ObjectClassification, PO); 6904 })) { 6905 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6906 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6907 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6908 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 6909 Candidate.Viable = false; 6910 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6911 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 6912 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6913 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6914 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 6915 ObjectType.isNull(); 6916 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6917 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6918 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6919 else { 6920 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6921 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6922 Info); 6923 } 6924 return; 6925 } 6926 6927 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6928 // deduction as a candidate. 6929 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 6930 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 6931 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 6932 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 6933 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 6934 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6935 Conversions, PO); 6936 } 6937 6938 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier 6939 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true. 6940 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) { 6941 return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit(); 6942 } 6943 6944 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 6945 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 6946 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 6947 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 6948 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6949 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6950 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6951 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, 6952 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6953 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO)) 6954 return; 6955 6956 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 6957 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 6958 // and substitution in this case. 6959 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 6960 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 6961 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6962 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6963 Candidate.Viable = false; 6964 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6965 return; 6966 } 6967 6968 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6969 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6970 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6971 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6972 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6973 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6974 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6975 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6976 // functions. 6977 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6978 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6979 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6980 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6981 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6982 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6983 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 6984 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6985 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO); 6986 })) { 6987 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6988 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6989 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6990 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6991 Candidate.Viable = false; 6992 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6993 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 6994 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6995 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6996 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 6997 // type. 6998 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6999 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 7000 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 7001 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7002 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7003 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7004 else { 7005 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7006 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7007 Info); 7008 } 7009 return; 7010 } 7011 7012 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7013 // deduction as a candidate. 7014 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7015 AddOverloadCandidate( 7016 Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 7017 PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit, 7018 /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO); 7019 } 7020 7021 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 7022 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 7023 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 7024 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 7025 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 7026 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7027 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7028 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 7029 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7030 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 7031 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 7032 // that is correct. 7033 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 7034 7035 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7036 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 7037 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 7038 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 7039 7040 Conversions = 7041 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 7042 7043 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7044 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7045 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7046 7047 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 7048 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 7049 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 7050 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 7051 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 7052 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 7053 Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7054 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 7055 Method, ActingContext); 7056 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7057 return true; 7058 } 7059 7060 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 7061 ++I) { 7062 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 7063 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 7064 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed 7065 ? 0 7066 : (ThisConversions + I); 7067 Conversions[ConvIdx] 7068 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 7069 SuppressUserConversions, 7070 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 7071 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7072 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 7073 AllowExplicit); 7074 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7075 return true; 7076 } 7077 } 7078 7079 return false; 7080 } 7081 7082 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 7083 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 7084 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 7085 /// 7086 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 7087 /// 7088 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 7089 /// 7090 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 7091 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 7092 /// 7093 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 7094 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 7095 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 7096 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 7097 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 7098 7099 // Easy case: the types are the same. 7100 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 7101 return true; 7102 7103 // Allow qualification conversions. 7104 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 7105 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 7106 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 7107 return true; 7108 7109 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 7110 // we're done. 7111 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 7112 return false; 7113 7114 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 7115 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 7116 QualType ConvertedType; 7117 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 7118 IncompatibleObjC); 7119 } 7120 7121 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 7122 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 7123 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 7124 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 7125 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 7126 /// conversion function produces). 7127 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate( 7128 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7129 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7130 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7131 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7132 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 7133 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 7134 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7135 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7136 return; 7137 7138 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 7139 // deduction now. 7140 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 7141 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 7142 return; 7143 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7144 } 7145 7146 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 7147 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 7148 if (!AllowResultConversion && 7149 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 7150 return; 7151 7152 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 7153 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 7154 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 7155 // 7156 // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we 7157 // can't select them. 7158 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 7159 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 7160 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 7161 return; 7162 7163 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7164 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7165 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7166 7167 // Add this candidate 7168 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 7169 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7170 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 7171 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7172 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7173 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7174 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 7175 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 7176 Candidate.Viable = true; 7177 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7178 7179 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 7180 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 7181 // to them in diagnostics. 7182 if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) { 7183 Candidate.Viable = false; 7184 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7185 return; 7186 } 7187 7188 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 7189 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 7190 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 7191 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 7192 // 7193 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7194 // object parameter. 7195 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 7196 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7197 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7198 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 7199 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 7200 7201 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7202 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 7203 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 7204 7205 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 7206 Candidate.Viable = false; 7207 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7208 return; 7209 } 7210 7211 if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 7212 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 7213 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) || 7214 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 7215 Candidate.Viable = false; 7216 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 7217 return; 7218 } 7219 } 7220 7221 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 7222 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 7223 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 7224 QualType FromCanon 7225 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 7226 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7227 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 7228 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 7229 Candidate.Viable = false; 7230 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 7231 return; 7232 } 7233 7234 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 7235 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 7236 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 7237 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 7238 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 7239 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 7240 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 7241 // well-formed. 7242 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 7243 VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc()); 7244 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 7245 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 7246 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 7247 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 7248 7249 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 7250 if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) { 7251 Candidate.Viable = false; 7252 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7253 return; 7254 } 7255 7256 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 7257 7258 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 7259 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 7260 // allocator). 7261 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7262 7263 alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)]; 7264 CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary( 7265 Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc()); 7266 7267 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7268 TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType, 7269 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 7270 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7271 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7272 7273 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 7274 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 7275 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 7276 7277 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 7278 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 7279 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 7280 // shall have exact match rank. 7281 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7282 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 7283 Candidate.Viable = false; 7284 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 7285 return; 7286 } 7287 7288 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 7289 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 7290 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 7291 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 7292 // program is ill-formed. 7293 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 7294 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 7295 Candidate.Viable = false; 7296 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7297 return; 7298 } 7299 break; 7300 7301 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 7302 Candidate.Viable = false; 7303 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7304 return; 7305 7306 default: 7307 llvm_unreachable( 7308 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 7309 } 7310 7311 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 7312 Candidate.Viable = false; 7313 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7314 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7315 return; 7316 } 7317 7318 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7319 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7320 Candidate.Viable = false; 7321 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7322 } 7323 } 7324 7325 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7326 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7327 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7328 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7329 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7330 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 7331 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7332 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7333 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7334 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7335 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7336 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7337 7338 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7339 return; 7340 7341 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7342 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7343 // and substitution in this case. 7344 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7345 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7346 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7347 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7348 Candidate.Viable = false; 7349 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7350 return; 7351 } 7352 7353 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7354 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7355 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7356 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7357 Specialization, Info)) { 7358 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7359 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7360 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7361 Candidate.Viable = false; 7362 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7363 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7364 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7365 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7366 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7367 Info); 7368 return; 7369 } 7370 7371 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7372 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7373 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7374 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7375 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7376 AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion); 7377 } 7378 7379 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7380 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7381 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7382 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7383 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7384 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7385 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7386 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7387 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7388 Expr *Object, 7389 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7390 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7391 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7392 return; 7393 7394 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7395 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7396 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7397 7398 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7399 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7400 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7401 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7402 Candidate.Viable = true; 7403 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7404 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7405 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7406 7407 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7408 // object parameter. 7409 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7410 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7411 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7412 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7413 Candidate.Viable = false; 7414 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7415 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7416 return; 7417 } 7418 7419 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7420 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7421 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7422 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7423 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7424 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7425 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7426 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7427 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7428 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7429 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7430 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7431 7432 // Find the 7433 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7434 7435 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7436 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7437 // list (8.3.5). 7438 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7439 Candidate.Viable = false; 7440 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7441 return; 7442 } 7443 7444 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7445 // we have enough arguments. 7446 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7447 // Not enough arguments. 7448 Candidate.Viable = false; 7449 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7450 return; 7451 } 7452 7453 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7454 // arguments. 7455 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7456 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7457 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7458 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7459 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7460 // parameter of F. 7461 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7462 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7463 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7464 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7465 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7466 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7467 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7468 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7469 Candidate.Viable = false; 7470 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7471 return; 7472 } 7473 } else { 7474 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7475 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7476 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7477 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7478 } 7479 } 7480 7481 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 7482 Candidate.Viable = false; 7483 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7484 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7485 return; 7486 } 7487 } 7488 7489 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given 7490 /// function set to the overload candidate set. 7491 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates( 7492 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7493 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7494 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 7495 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 7496 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 7497 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 7498 7499 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 7500 FunctionDecl *FD = 7501 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 7502 7503 // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting. 7504 if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD)) 7505 continue; 7506 7507 assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 7508 "unqualified operator lookup found a member function"); 7509 7510 if (FunTmpl) { 7511 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7512 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7513 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7514 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7515 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7516 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false, 7517 true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7518 } else { 7519 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7520 continue; 7521 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7522 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7523 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), 7524 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, 7525 false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL, 7526 None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7527 } 7528 } 7529 } 7530 7531 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7532 /// member functions. 7533 /// 7534 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7535 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7536 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7537 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7538 /// [over.match.oper]). 7539 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7540 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7541 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7542 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7543 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7544 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7545 7546 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7547 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7548 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7549 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7550 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7551 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7552 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7553 // constructed as follows: 7554 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7555 7556 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7557 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7558 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7559 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7560 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7561 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7562 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7563 return; 7564 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7565 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7566 return; 7567 7568 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7569 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7570 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7571 7572 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7573 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7574 Oper != OperEnd; 7575 ++Oper) 7576 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7577 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7578 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO); 7579 } 7580 } 7581 7582 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7583 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7584 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7585 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7586 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7587 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7588 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7589 /// converted to bool. 7590 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7591 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7592 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7593 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7594 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7595 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7596 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7597 7598 // Add this candidate 7599 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7600 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7601 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7602 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7603 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7604 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7605 7606 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7607 // arguments. 7608 Candidate.Viable = true; 7609 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7610 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7611 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7612 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7613 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7614 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7615 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7616 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7617 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7618 // 7619 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7620 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7621 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7622 // is not of the same type. 7623 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7624 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7625 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7626 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7627 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7628 } else { 7629 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7630 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7631 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7632 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7633 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7634 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7635 } 7636 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7637 Candidate.Viable = false; 7638 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7639 break; 7640 } 7641 } 7642 } 7643 7644 namespace { 7645 7646 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7647 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7648 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7649 /// enumeration types. 7650 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7651 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7652 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7653 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7654 7655 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7656 /// built-in candidates. 7657 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7658 7659 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7660 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7661 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7662 7663 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7664 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7665 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7666 7667 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7668 /// candidates. 7669 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7670 7671 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7672 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7673 7674 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7675 /// were present in the candidate set. 7676 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7677 7678 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7679 /// candidate set. 7680 bool HasNullPtrType; 7681 7682 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7683 /// candidate type set. 7684 Sema &SemaRef; 7685 7686 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7687 ASTContext &Context; 7688 7689 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7690 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7691 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7692 7693 public: 7694 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7695 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7696 7697 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7698 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7699 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7700 HasNullPtrType(false), 7701 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7702 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7703 7704 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7705 SourceLocation Loc, 7706 bool AllowUserConversions, 7707 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7708 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7709 7710 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 7711 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 7712 7713 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 7714 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 7715 7716 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 7717 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 7718 7719 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 7720 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 7721 7722 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 7723 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 7724 7725 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 7726 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 7727 7728 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 7729 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 7730 7731 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7732 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7733 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7734 }; 7735 7736 } // end anonymous namespace 7737 7738 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7739 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7740 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7741 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7742 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7743 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7744 /// false otherwise. 7745 /// 7746 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7747 bool 7748 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7749 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7750 7751 // Insert this type. 7752 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7753 return false; 7754 7755 QualType PointeeTy; 7756 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7757 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7758 if (!PointerTy) { 7759 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7760 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7761 buildObjCPtr = true; 7762 } else { 7763 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7764 } 7765 7766 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7767 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7768 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7769 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7770 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7771 return true; 7772 7773 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7774 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7775 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7776 7777 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7778 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7779 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7780 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7781 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7782 7783 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7784 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7785 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7786 (!hasRestrict || 7787 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7788 continue; 7789 7790 // Build qualified pointee type. 7791 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7792 7793 // Build qualified pointer type. 7794 QualType QPointerTy; 7795 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7796 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7797 else 7798 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7799 7800 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7801 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7802 } 7803 7804 return true; 7805 } 7806 7807 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7808 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7809 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7810 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7811 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7812 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7813 /// false otherwise. 7814 /// 7815 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7816 bool 7817 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7818 QualType Ty) { 7819 // Insert this type. 7820 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7821 return false; 7822 7823 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7824 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7825 7826 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7827 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7828 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7829 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7830 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7831 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7832 return true; 7833 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7834 7835 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7836 // qualifiers. 7837 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7838 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7839 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7840 7841 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7842 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7843 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7844 } 7845 7846 return true; 7847 } 7848 7849 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7850 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7851 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7852 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7853 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7854 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7855 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7856 /// type. 7857 void 7858 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7859 SourceLocation Loc, 7860 bool AllowUserConversions, 7861 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7862 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7863 // Only deal with canonical types. 7864 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 7865 7866 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 7867 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 7868 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7869 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 7870 7871 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 7872 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 7873 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 7874 7875 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 7876 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 7877 7878 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 7879 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7880 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 7881 7882 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 7883 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 7884 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 7885 7886 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 7887 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 7888 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 7889 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 7890 // of types. 7891 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 7892 return; 7893 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 7894 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 7895 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 7896 return; 7897 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 7898 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7899 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 7900 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 7901 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 7902 // extension. 7903 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7904 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 7905 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 7906 HasNullPtrType = true; 7907 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 7908 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 7909 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 7910 return; 7911 7912 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7913 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7914 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7915 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7916 7917 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 7918 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 7919 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 7920 continue; 7921 7922 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 7923 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 7924 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 7925 VisibleQuals); 7926 } 7927 } 7928 } 7929 } 7930 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference 7931 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument. 7932 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 7933 Expr *Arg) { 7934 return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace()); 7935 } 7936 7937 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 7938 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 7939 /// given type to the candidate set. 7940 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 7941 QualType T, 7942 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7943 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 7944 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7945 7946 // T& operator=(T&, T) 7947 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7948 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0])); 7949 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7950 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7951 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7952 7953 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 7954 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 7955 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7956 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T), 7957 Args[0])); 7958 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7959 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7960 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7961 } 7962 } 7963 7964 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 7965 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 7966 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 7967 Qualifiers VRQuals; 7968 const RecordType *TyRec; 7969 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 7970 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7971 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7972 else 7973 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7974 if (!TyRec) { 7975 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 7976 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7977 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7978 return VRQuals; 7979 } 7980 7981 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7982 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 7983 return VRQuals; 7984 7985 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7986 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7987 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7988 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 7989 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 7990 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7991 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 7992 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 7993 // as see them. 7994 bool done = false; 7995 while (!done) { 7996 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 7997 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7998 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7999 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8000 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 8001 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8002 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 8003 else 8004 done = true; 8005 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 8006 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8007 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 8008 return VRQuals; 8009 } 8010 } 8011 } 8012 return VRQuals; 8013 } 8014 8015 namespace { 8016 8017 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 8018 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 8019 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 8020 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 8021 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 8022 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 8023 Sema &S; 8024 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 8025 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8026 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 8027 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 8028 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 8029 8030 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 8031 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 8032 8033 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in 8034 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 8035 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 8036 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 8037 LastIntegralType; 8038 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 8039 LastPromotedIntegralType; 8040 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 8041 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 8042 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 8043 8044 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 8045 // Start of promoted types. 8046 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 8047 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 8048 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 8049 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 8050 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 8051 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 8052 8053 // Start of integral types. 8054 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8055 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8056 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 8057 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 8058 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 8059 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8060 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 8061 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 8062 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 8063 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 8064 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8065 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 8066 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8067 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8068 // End of promoted types. 8069 8070 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 8071 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 8072 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 8073 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 8074 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 8075 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 8076 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 8077 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 8078 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 8079 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 8080 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 8081 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8082 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8083 // End of integral types. 8084 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 8085 8086 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 8087 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 8088 } 8089 8090 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 8091 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 8092 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 8093 bool HasVolatile, 8094 bool HasRestrict) { 8095 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8096 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 8097 S.Context.IntTy 8098 }; 8099 8100 // Non-volatile version. 8101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8102 8103 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 8104 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 8105 if (HasVolatile) { 8106 ParamTypes[0] = 8107 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8108 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 8109 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8110 } 8111 8112 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 8113 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 8114 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 8115 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 8116 ParamTypes[0] 8117 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8118 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 8119 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8120 8121 if (HasVolatile) { 8122 ParamTypes[0] 8123 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8124 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 8125 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8126 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8127 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8128 } 8129 } 8130 8131 } 8132 8133 public: 8134 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 8135 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8136 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8137 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8138 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 8139 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 8140 : S(S), Args(Args), 8141 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 8142 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 8143 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 8144 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 8145 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 8146 8147 InitArithmeticTypes(); 8148 } 8149 8150 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 8151 // 8152 // C++ [over.built]p3: 8153 // 8154 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8155 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8156 // candidate operator functions of the form 8157 // 8158 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 8159 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 8160 // 8161 // C++ [over.built]p4: 8162 // 8163 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8164 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8165 // candidate operator functions of the form 8166 // 8167 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 8168 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 8169 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8170 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8171 return; 8172 8173 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 8174 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8175 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 8176 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 8177 continue; 8178 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 8179 continue; 8180 } 8181 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8182 TypeOfT, 8183 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 8184 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 8185 } 8186 } 8187 8188 // C++ [over.built]p5: 8189 // 8190 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8191 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 8192 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8193 // 8194 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 8195 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 8196 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 8197 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 8198 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 8199 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8200 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8201 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8202 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8203 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 8204 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8205 continue; 8206 8207 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 8208 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8209 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 8210 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8211 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 8212 } 8213 } 8214 8215 // C++ [over.built]p6: 8216 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 8217 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8218 // 8219 // T& operator*(T*); 8220 // 8221 // C++ [over.built]p7: 8222 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 8223 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8224 // T& operator*(T*); 8225 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 8226 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8227 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8228 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8229 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8230 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8231 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 8232 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8233 continue; 8234 8235 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 8236 if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 8237 continue; 8238 8239 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8240 } 8241 } 8242 8243 // C++ [over.built]p9: 8244 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 8245 // operator functions of the form 8246 // 8247 // T operator+(T); 8248 // T operator-(T); 8249 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 8250 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8251 return; 8252 8253 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8254 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 8255 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8256 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8257 } 8258 8259 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 8260 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8261 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8262 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8263 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 8264 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 8265 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8266 } 8267 } 8268 8269 // C++ [over.built]p8: 8270 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 8271 // the form 8272 // 8273 // T* operator+(T*); 8274 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 8275 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8276 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8277 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8278 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8279 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8280 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8281 } 8282 } 8283 8284 // C++ [over.built]p10: 8285 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 8286 // operator functions of the form 8287 // 8288 // T operator~(T); 8289 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 8290 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8291 return; 8292 8293 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8294 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 8295 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 8296 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8297 } 8298 8299 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 8300 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8301 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8302 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8303 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 8304 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 8305 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8306 } 8307 } 8308 8309 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 8310 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 8311 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8312 // 8313 // bool operator==(T,T); 8314 // bool operator!=(T,T); 8315 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 8316 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8317 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8318 8319 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8320 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8321 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8322 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8323 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 8324 ++MemPtr) { 8325 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8326 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8327 continue; 8328 8329 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8330 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8331 } 8332 8333 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 8334 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 8335 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 8336 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 8337 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8338 } 8339 } 8340 } 8341 } 8342 8343 // C++ [over.built]p15: 8344 // 8345 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 8346 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8347 // 8348 // bool operator<(T, T); 8349 // bool operator>(T, T); 8350 // bool operator<=(T, T); 8351 // bool operator>=(T, T); 8352 // bool operator==(T, T); 8353 // bool operator!=(T, T); 8354 // R operator<=>(T, T) 8355 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8356 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8357 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 8358 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 8359 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 8360 // candidate. 8361 // 8362 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 8363 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 8364 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 8365 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 8366 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 8367 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 8368 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 8369 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 8370 8371 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8372 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 8373 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 8374 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 8375 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8376 C != CEnd; ++C) { 8377 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 8378 continue; 8379 8380 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8381 continue; 8382 8383 // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the 8384 // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters 8385 // reversed", not to the original function. 8386 bool Reversed = C->RewriteKind & CRK_Reversed; 8387 QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0) 8388 ->getType() 8389 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8390 QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1) 8391 ->getType() 8392 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8393 8394 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8395 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8396 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8397 continue; 8398 8399 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8400 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8401 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8402 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8403 } 8404 } 8405 } 8406 8407 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8408 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8409 8410 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8411 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8412 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8413 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8414 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8415 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8416 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8417 continue; 8418 8419 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8420 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8421 } 8422 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8423 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8424 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8425 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8426 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 8427 8428 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8429 // candidate exists. 8430 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8431 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8432 CanonType))) 8433 continue; 8434 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8435 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8436 } 8437 } 8438 } 8439 8440 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8441 // 8442 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8443 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8444 // 8445 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8446 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8447 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8448 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8449 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8450 // 8451 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8452 // 8453 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8454 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8455 // 8456 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8457 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8458 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8459 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8460 8461 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8462 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8463 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8464 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8465 }; 8466 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8467 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 8468 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 8469 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8470 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8471 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8472 continue; 8473 8474 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 8475 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8476 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8477 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8478 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8479 } 8480 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8481 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8482 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8483 continue; 8484 8485 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8486 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8487 } 8488 } 8489 } 8490 } 8491 8492 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8493 // 8494 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8495 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8496 // 8497 // LR operator*(L, R); 8498 // LR operator/(L, R); 8499 // LR operator+(L, R); 8500 // LR operator-(L, R); 8501 // bool operator<(L, R); 8502 // bool operator>(L, R); 8503 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8504 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8505 // bool operator==(L, R); 8506 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8507 // 8508 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8509 // between types L and R. 8510 // 8511 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8512 // 8513 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8514 // candidate operator functions of the form 8515 // 8516 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8517 // 8518 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8519 // between types L and R. 8520 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8521 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8522 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8523 return; 8524 8525 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8526 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8527 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8528 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8529 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8530 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8531 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8532 } 8533 } 8534 8535 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8536 // conditional operator for vector types. 8537 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8538 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8539 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8540 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8541 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8542 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8543 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8544 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8545 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 8546 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8547 } 8548 } 8549 } 8550 8551 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8552 // 8553 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8554 // of the form 8555 // 8556 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8557 // 8558 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8559 // 8560 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8561 // operator function of the form 8562 // 8563 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8564 // 8565 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8566 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8567 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8568 // overload resolution. For example: 8569 // 8570 // enum A : int {a}; 8571 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8572 // 8573 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8574 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8575 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8576 // 8577 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8578 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8579 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8580 // 8581 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8582 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8583 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8584 } 8585 8586 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8587 // 8588 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8589 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8590 // 8591 // LR operator%(L, R); 8592 // LR operator&(L, R); 8593 // LR operator^(L, R); 8594 // LR operator|(L, R); 8595 // L operator<<(L, R); 8596 // L operator>>(L, R); 8597 // 8598 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8599 // between types L and R. 8600 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8601 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8602 return; 8603 8604 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8605 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8606 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8607 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8608 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8609 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8610 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8611 } 8612 } 8613 } 8614 8615 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8616 // 8617 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8618 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8619 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8620 // 8621 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8622 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8623 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8624 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8625 8626 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8627 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8628 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8629 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8630 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8631 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8632 continue; 8633 8634 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 8635 } 8636 8637 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8638 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8639 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8640 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8641 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8642 continue; 8643 8644 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 8645 } 8646 } 8647 } 8648 8649 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8650 // 8651 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8652 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8653 // of the form 8654 // 8655 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8656 // 8657 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8658 // 8659 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8660 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8661 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8662 // 8663 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8664 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8665 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8666 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8667 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8668 8669 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8670 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8671 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8672 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8673 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8674 if (isEqualOp) 8675 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 8676 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8677 continue; 8678 8679 // non-volatile version 8680 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8681 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8682 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8683 }; 8684 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8685 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8686 8687 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8688 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8689 if (NeedVolatile) { 8690 // volatile version 8691 ParamTypes[0] = 8692 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8693 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8694 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8695 } 8696 8697 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8698 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8699 // restrict version 8700 ParamTypes[0] 8701 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8702 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8703 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8704 8705 if (NeedVolatile) { 8706 // volatile restrict version 8707 ParamTypes[0] 8708 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8709 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8710 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8711 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8712 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8713 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8714 } 8715 } 8716 } 8717 8718 if (isEqualOp) { 8719 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8720 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8721 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8722 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8723 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8724 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8725 continue; 8726 8727 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8728 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8729 *Ptr, 8730 }; 8731 8732 // non-volatile version 8733 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8734 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8735 8736 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8737 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8738 if (NeedVolatile) { 8739 // volatile version 8740 ParamTypes[0] = 8741 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8742 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8743 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8744 } 8745 8746 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8747 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8748 // restrict version 8749 ParamTypes[0] 8750 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8751 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8752 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8753 8754 if (NeedVolatile) { 8755 // volatile restrict version 8756 ParamTypes[0] 8757 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8758 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8759 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8760 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8761 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8762 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8763 } 8764 } 8765 } 8766 } 8767 } 8768 8769 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8770 // 8771 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8772 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8773 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8774 // the form 8775 // 8776 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8777 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8778 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8779 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8780 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8781 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8782 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8783 return; 8784 8785 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8786 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8787 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8788 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8789 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8790 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8791 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8792 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8793 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8794 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8795 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8796 8797 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8798 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8799 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy); 8800 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8801 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8802 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8803 } 8804 } 8805 } 8806 8807 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8808 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8809 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8810 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8811 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8812 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8813 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8814 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8815 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8816 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8817 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 8818 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8819 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 8820 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8821 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8822 8823 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8824 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8825 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 8826 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8827 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8828 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8829 } 8830 } 8831 } 8832 } 8833 8834 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8835 // 8836 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8837 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8838 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8839 // 8840 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8841 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8842 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8843 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8844 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8845 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8846 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8847 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8848 return; 8849 8850 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8851 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8852 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8853 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8854 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8855 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8856 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8857 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8858 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8859 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8860 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8861 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8862 ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy; 8863 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8864 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8865 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8866 } 8867 } 8868 } 8869 } 8870 8871 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8872 // 8873 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8874 // 8875 // bool operator!(bool); 8876 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8877 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8878 void addExclaimOverload() { 8879 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8880 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8881 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8882 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8883 } 8884 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8885 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8886 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8887 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8888 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8889 } 8890 8891 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8892 // 8893 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 8894 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8895 // 8896 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8897 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 8898 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8899 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 8900 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 8901 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 8902 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8903 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8904 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8905 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8906 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 8907 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8908 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8909 continue; 8910 8911 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 8912 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8913 } 8914 8915 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8916 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8917 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8918 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8919 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 8920 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8921 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8922 continue; 8923 8924 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 8925 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8926 } 8927 } 8928 8929 // C++ [over.built]p11: 8930 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 8931 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 8932 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 8933 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8934 // 8935 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 8936 // 8937 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 8938 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 8939 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8940 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8941 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8942 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8943 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 8944 QualType C1; 8945 QualifierCollector Q1; 8946 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 8947 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 8948 continue; 8949 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 8950 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 8951 // volatile/restrict type. 8952 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 8953 continue; 8954 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 8955 continue; 8956 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8957 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 8958 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 8959 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8960 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 8961 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 8962 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 8963 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 8964 break; 8965 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 8966 // build CV12 T& 8967 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 8968 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 8969 T.isVolatileQualified()) 8970 continue; 8971 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 8972 T.isRestrictQualified()) 8973 continue; 8974 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 8975 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8976 } 8977 } 8978 } 8979 8980 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 8981 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 8982 // therefore added as binary. 8983 // 8984 // C++ [over.built]p25: 8985 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 8986 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8987 // 8988 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 8989 // 8990 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 8991 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8992 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8993 8994 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8995 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8996 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8997 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8998 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8999 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 9000 continue; 9001 9002 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 9003 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9004 } 9005 9006 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9007 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 9008 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 9009 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 9010 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 9011 continue; 9012 9013 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 9014 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9015 } 9016 9017 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9018 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9019 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 9020 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 9021 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 9022 if (!(*Enum)->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 9023 continue; 9024 9025 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 9026 continue; 9027 9028 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 9029 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9030 } 9031 } 9032 } 9033 } 9034 }; 9035 9036 } // end anonymous namespace 9037 9038 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 9039 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 9040 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 9041 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 9042 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 9043 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9044 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9045 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9046 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 9047 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 9048 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 9049 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 9050 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 9051 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 9052 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 9053 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 9054 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 9055 9056 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 9057 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 9058 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 9059 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 9060 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 9061 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 9062 OpLoc, 9063 true, 9064 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 9065 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 9066 Op == OO_PipePipe), 9067 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 9068 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 9069 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 9070 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 9071 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 9072 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 9073 } 9074 9075 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 9076 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 9077 // 9078 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 9079 // 'bool' overloads. 9080 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 9081 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 9082 return; 9083 9084 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 9085 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 9086 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 9087 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 9088 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 9089 9090 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 9091 switch (Op) { 9092 case OO_None: 9093 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 9094 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 9095 9096 case OO_New: 9097 case OO_Delete: 9098 case OO_Array_New: 9099 case OO_Array_Delete: 9100 case OO_Call: 9101 llvm_unreachable( 9102 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 9103 9104 case OO_Comma: 9105 case OO_Arrow: 9106 case OO_Coawait: 9107 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9108 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 9109 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 9110 // built-in candidates set is empty. 9111 break; 9112 9113 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 9114 if (Args.size() == 1) 9115 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 9116 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9117 9118 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 9119 if (Args.size() == 1) { 9120 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 9121 } else { 9122 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 9123 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9124 } 9125 break; 9126 9127 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 9128 if (Args.size() == 1) 9129 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 9130 else 9131 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9132 break; 9133 9134 case OO_Slash: 9135 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9136 break; 9137 9138 case OO_PlusPlus: 9139 case OO_MinusMinus: 9140 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9141 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 9142 break; 9143 9144 case OO_EqualEqual: 9145 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 9146 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 9147 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9148 9149 case OO_Less: 9150 case OO_Greater: 9151 case OO_LessEqual: 9152 case OO_GreaterEqual: 9153 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9154 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9155 break; 9156 9157 case OO_Spaceship: 9158 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9159 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 9160 break; 9161 9162 case OO_Percent: 9163 case OO_Caret: 9164 case OO_Pipe: 9165 case OO_LessLess: 9166 case OO_GreaterGreater: 9167 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9168 break; 9169 9170 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 9171 if (Args.size() == 1) 9172 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9173 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 9174 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 9175 break; 9176 9177 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9178 break; 9179 9180 case OO_Tilde: 9181 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 9182 break; 9183 9184 case OO_Equal: 9185 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9186 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9187 9188 case OO_PlusEqual: 9189 case OO_MinusEqual: 9190 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9191 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9192 9193 case OO_StarEqual: 9194 case OO_SlashEqual: 9195 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9196 break; 9197 9198 case OO_PercentEqual: 9199 case OO_LessLessEqual: 9200 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 9201 case OO_AmpEqual: 9202 case OO_CaretEqual: 9203 case OO_PipeEqual: 9204 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 9205 break; 9206 9207 case OO_Exclaim: 9208 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 9209 break; 9210 9211 case OO_AmpAmp: 9212 case OO_PipePipe: 9213 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 9214 break; 9215 9216 case OO_Subscript: 9217 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 9218 break; 9219 9220 case OO_ArrowStar: 9221 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 9222 break; 9223 9224 case OO_Conditional: 9225 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 9226 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9227 break; 9228 } 9229 } 9230 9231 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 9232 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 9233 /// 9234 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 9235 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 9236 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 9237 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 9238 void 9239 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 9240 SourceLocation Loc, 9241 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9242 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9243 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 9244 bool PartialOverloading) { 9245 ADLResult Fns; 9246 9247 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 9248 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 9249 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 9250 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 9251 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 9252 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 9253 9254 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 9255 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 9256 9257 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 9258 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 9259 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 9260 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 9261 if (Cand->Function) { 9262 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 9263 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 9264 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 9265 } 9266 9267 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 9268 // set. 9269 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9270 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 9271 9272 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 9273 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 9274 continue; 9275 9276 AddOverloadCandidate( 9277 FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 9278 PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 9279 /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9280 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) { 9281 AddOverloadCandidate( 9282 FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 9283 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9284 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, 9285 ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9286 } 9287 } else { 9288 auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I); 9289 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9290 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 9291 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9292 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9293 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed( 9294 Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9295 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9296 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 9297 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9298 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL, 9299 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9300 } 9301 } 9302 } 9303 } 9304 9305 namespace { 9306 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 9307 } 9308 9309 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 9310 /// overload resolution. 9311 /// 9312 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 9313 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 9314 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 9315 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 9316 /// 9317 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 9318 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 9319 /// worse than Cand1's. 9320 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 9321 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 9322 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 9323 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9324 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9325 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 9326 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 9327 return Comparison::Equal; 9328 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 9329 } 9330 9331 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9332 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9333 9334 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 9335 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) { 9336 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair); 9337 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair); 9338 9339 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 9340 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa. 9341 if (!Cand1A) 9342 return Comparison::Worse; 9343 if (!Cand2A) 9344 return Comparison::Better; 9345 9346 Cand1ID.clear(); 9347 Cand2ID.clear(); 9348 9349 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9350 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9351 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 9352 return Comparison::Worse; 9353 } 9354 9355 return Comparison::Equal; 9356 } 9357 9358 static bool isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 9359 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) { 9360 if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function || 9361 !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion()) 9362 return false; 9363 9364 // If Cand1 is invalid, it cannot be a better match, if Cand2 is invalid, this 9365 // is obviously better. 9366 if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) return false; 9367 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) return true; 9368 9369 // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer 9370 // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers. 9371 bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9372 bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9373 const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9374 const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9375 9376 if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec) 9377 return false; 9378 9379 if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp) 9380 return true; 9381 if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp) 9382 return false; 9383 9384 if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) { 9385 if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()) 9386 return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size(); 9387 9388 std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator> 9389 FirstDiff = std::mismatch( 9390 Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(), 9391 Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 9392 [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) { 9393 return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName(); 9394 }); 9395 9396 assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() && 9397 "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same " 9398 "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!"); 9399 return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName(); 9400 } 9401 llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch"); 9402 } 9403 9404 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 9405 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 9406 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 9407 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 9408 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 9409 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 9410 // functions. 9411 if (!Cand2.Viable) 9412 return Cand1.Viable; 9413 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 9414 return false; 9415 9416 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9417 // 9418 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 9419 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 9420 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 9421 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 9422 unsigned StartArg = 0; 9423 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 9424 StartArg = 1; 9425 9426 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 9427 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 9428 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9429 return ICS.isStandard() && 9430 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 9431 9432 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 9433 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 9434 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 9435 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 9436 }; 9437 9438 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 9439 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 9440 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 9441 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 9442 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 9443 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9444 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9445 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9446 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 9447 if (Cand1Bad) 9448 return false; 9449 HasBetterConversion = true; 9450 } 9451 } 9452 9453 if (HasBetterConversion) 9454 return true; 9455 9456 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9457 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9458 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9459 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9460 bool HasWorseConversion = false; 9461 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9462 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9463 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9464 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9465 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9466 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9467 HasBetterConversion = true; 9468 break; 9469 9470 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9471 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function == Cand2.Function && 9472 (Cand2.RewriteKind & CRK_Reversed) != 0) { 9473 // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed 9474 // forms of operator== in C++20: 9475 // 9476 // When comparing a function against its reversed form, if we have a 9477 // better conversion for one argument and a worse conversion for the 9478 // other, we prefer the non-reversed form. 9479 // 9480 // This prevents a conversion function from being considered ambiguous 9481 // with its own reversed form in various where it's only incidentally 9482 // heterogeneous. 9483 // 9484 // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp. 9485 HasWorseConversion = true; 9486 break; 9487 } 9488 9489 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9490 return false; 9491 9492 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9493 // Do nothing. 9494 break; 9495 } 9496 } 9497 9498 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9499 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9500 if (HasBetterConversion) 9501 return true; 9502 if (HasWorseConversion) 9503 return false; 9504 9505 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9506 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9507 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9508 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9509 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9510 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9511 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9512 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9513 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9514 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9515 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9516 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9517 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9518 // pointer or block. 9519 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9520 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9521 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9522 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9523 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9524 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9525 9526 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9527 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9528 9529 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9530 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9531 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9532 } 9533 9534 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9535 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9536 // 9537 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9538 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9539 // a conversion function. 9540 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9541 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9542 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9543 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9544 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9545 9546 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9547 // specialization, or, if not that, 9548 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9549 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9550 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9551 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9552 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9553 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9554 9555 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9556 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9557 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9558 // if not that, 9559 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9560 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 9561 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9562 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9563 Loc, 9564 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 9565 : TPOC_Call, 9566 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, 9567 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments)) 9568 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9569 } 9570 9571 // -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same 9572 // parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...], 9573 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization && 9574 !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() && 9575 Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) { 9576 auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType()); 9577 auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType()); 9578 if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() && 9579 PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() && 9580 S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) { 9581 Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9582 Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9583 if (RC1 && RC2) { 9584 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 9585 if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function, 9586 {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) || 9587 S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function, 9588 {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 9589 return false; 9590 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2) 9591 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 9592 } else if (RC1 || RC2) { 9593 return RC1 != nullptr; 9594 } 9595 } 9596 } 9597 9598 // -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base 9599 // class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of 9600 // F1 and F2 have the same type. 9601 // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check. 9602 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9603 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9604 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9605 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9606 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9607 return Cand2IsInherited; 9608 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9609 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9610 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9611 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9612 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9613 return true; 9614 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9615 return false; 9616 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9617 } 9618 9619 // -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not 9620 // -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate 9621 // with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not 9622 // 9623 // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but 9624 // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for 9625 // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>). 9626 if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind) 9627 return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind; 9628 9629 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9630 { 9631 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9632 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9633 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9634 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9635 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9636 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9637 9638 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9639 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9640 return true; 9641 } 9642 } 9643 9644 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9645 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9646 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9647 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9648 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9649 } 9650 9651 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9652 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9653 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9654 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9655 } 9656 9657 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9658 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9659 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9660 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9661 if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1) 9662 return true; 9663 9664 return isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2); 9665 } 9666 9667 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9668 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9669 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9670 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9671 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9672 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9673 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9674 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9675 const NamedDecl *B) { 9676 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9677 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9678 if (!VA || !VB) 9679 return false; 9680 9681 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9682 // entity in different modules. 9683 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9684 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9685 getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) || 9686 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9687 return false; 9688 9689 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9690 // 9691 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9692 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9693 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9694 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9695 return true; 9696 9697 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9698 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9699 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9700 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9701 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9702 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9703 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9704 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9705 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9706 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9707 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9708 return false; 9709 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9710 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9711 } 9712 } 9713 9714 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9715 return false; 9716 } 9717 9718 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9719 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9720 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9721 9722 Module *M = getOwningModule(D); 9723 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9724 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9725 9726 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9727 Module *M = getOwningModule(E); 9728 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9729 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9730 } 9731 } 9732 9733 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9734 /// within an overload candidate set. 9735 /// 9736 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9737 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9738 /// 9739 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9740 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9741 /// 9742 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9743 OverloadingResult 9744 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9745 iterator &Best) { 9746 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9747 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9748 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9749 9750 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9751 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9752 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9753 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9754 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9755 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9756 // the WrongSide candidate. 9757 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9758 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9759 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9760 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9761 // Check viable function only. 9762 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9763 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9764 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9765 }); 9766 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9767 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9768 // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving. 9769 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9770 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9771 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9772 }; 9773 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9774 } 9775 } 9776 9777 // Find the best viable function. 9778 Best = end(); 9779 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9780 Cand->Best = false; 9781 if (Cand->Viable) 9782 if (Best == end() || 9783 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 9784 Best = Cand; 9785 } 9786 9787 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 9788 if (Best == end()) 9789 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 9790 9791 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 9792 9793 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest; 9794 PendingBest.push_back(&*Best); 9795 Best->Best = true; 9796 9797 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 9798 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 9799 while (!PendingBest.empty()) { 9800 auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val(); 9801 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9802 if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best && 9803 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 9804 PendingBest.push_back(Cand); 9805 Cand->Best = true; 9806 9807 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function, 9808 Curr->Function)) 9809 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 9810 else 9811 Best = end(); 9812 } 9813 } 9814 } 9815 9816 // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous. 9817 if (Best == end()) 9818 return OR_Ambiguous; 9819 9820 // Best is the best viable function. 9821 if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted()) 9822 return OR_Deleted; 9823 9824 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 9825 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 9826 EquivalentCands); 9827 9828 return OR_Success; 9829 } 9830 9831 namespace { 9832 9833 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 9834 oc_function, 9835 oc_method, 9836 oc_reversed_binary_operator, 9837 oc_constructor, 9838 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 9839 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 9840 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 9841 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 9842 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 9843 oc_implicit_equality_comparison, 9844 oc_inherited_constructor 9845 }; 9846 9847 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 9848 ocs_non_template, 9849 ocs_template, 9850 ocs_described_template, 9851 }; 9852 9853 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 9854 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9855 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK, 9856 std::string &Description) { 9857 9858 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 9859 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 9860 isTemplate = true; 9861 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9862 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 9863 } 9864 9865 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 9866 if (!Description.empty()) 9867 return ocs_described_template; 9868 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 9869 }(); 9870 9871 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 9872 if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual) 9873 return oc_implicit_equality_comparison; 9874 9875 if (CRK & CRK_Reversed) 9876 return oc_reversed_binary_operator; 9877 9878 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 9879 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 9880 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 9881 return oc_inherited_constructor; 9882 else 9883 return oc_constructor; 9884 } 9885 9886 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 9887 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 9888 9889 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 9890 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 9891 9892 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 9893 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 9894 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 9895 } 9896 9897 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 9898 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 9899 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 9900 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 9901 return oc_method; 9902 9903 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 9904 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 9905 9906 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 9907 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 9908 9909 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 9910 return oc_method; 9911 } 9912 9913 return oc_function; 9914 }(); 9915 9916 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 9917 } 9918 9919 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 9920 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 9921 // set. 9922 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 9923 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 9924 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 9925 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 9926 } 9927 9928 } // end anonymous namespace 9929 9930 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 9931 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9932 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 9933 bool AlwaysTrue; 9934 if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 9935 !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 9936 return false; 9937 if (!AlwaysTrue) 9938 return false; 9939 } 9940 return true; 9941 } 9942 9943 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 9944 /// 9945 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 9946 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 9947 /// we in overload resolution? 9948 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 9949 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 9950 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 9951 bool Complain, 9952 bool InOverloadResolution, 9953 SourceLocation Loc) { 9954 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 9955 if (Complain) { 9956 if (InOverloadResolution) 9957 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 9958 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 9959 else 9960 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 9961 } 9962 return false; 9963 } 9964 9965 if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 9966 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 9967 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc)) 9968 return false; 9969 if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 9970 if (Complain) { 9971 if (InOverloadResolution) 9972 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 9973 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints); 9974 else 9975 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied) 9976 << FD; 9977 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 9978 } 9979 return false; 9980 } 9981 } 9982 9983 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 9984 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 9985 }); 9986 if (I == FD->param_end()) 9987 return true; 9988 9989 if (Complain) { 9990 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 9991 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 9992 if (InOverloadResolution) 9993 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 9994 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 9995 << ParamNo; 9996 else 9997 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 9998 << FD << ParamNo; 9999 } 10000 return false; 10001 } 10002 10003 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 10004 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10005 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 10006 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10007 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 10008 } 10009 10010 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 10011 bool Complain, 10012 SourceLocation Loc) { 10013 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 10014 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 10015 Loc); 10016 } 10017 10018 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 10019 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10020 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind, 10021 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 10022 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 10023 return; 10024 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 10025 !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 10026 return; 10027 10028 std::string FnDesc; 10029 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 10030 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc); 10031 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10032 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 10033 << Fn << FnDesc; 10034 10035 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 10036 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 10037 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 10038 } 10039 10040 static void 10041 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) { 10042 // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are 10043 // 'identical' but not equivalent: 10044 // 10045 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1 10046 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2 10047 // 10048 // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause 10049 // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent 10050 // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same 10051 // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try 10052 // to help the user figure out what happened. 10053 10054 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC; 10055 FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr; 10056 for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10057 if (!I->Function) 10058 continue; 10059 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC; 10060 if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 10061 Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10062 else 10063 I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10064 if (AC.empty()) 10065 continue; 10066 if (FirstCand == nullptr) { 10067 FirstCand = I->Function; 10068 FirstAC = AC; 10069 } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) { 10070 SecondCand = I->Function; 10071 SecondAC = AC; 10072 } else { 10073 // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is 10074 // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it. 10075 return; 10076 } 10077 } 10078 if (!SecondCand) 10079 return; 10080 // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on 10081 // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint). 10082 if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC, 10083 SecondCand, SecondAC)) 10084 // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out 10085 // from here. 10086 return; 10087 } 10088 10089 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 10090 // OverloadedExpr 10091 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 10092 bool TakingAddress) { 10093 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10094 10095 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 10096 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 10097 10098 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10099 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10100 I != IEnd; ++I) { 10101 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 10102 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10103 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType, 10104 TakingAddress); 10105 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 10106 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10107 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress); 10108 } 10109 } 10110 } 10111 10112 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 10113 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 10114 /// target types of the conversion. 10115 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10116 Sema &S, 10117 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10118 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 10119 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 10120 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 10121 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 10122 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 10123 // refactoring here. 10124 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10125 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10126 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 10127 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10128 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10129 break; 10130 ++CandsShown; 10131 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 10132 } 10133 if (I != E) 10134 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10135 } 10136 10137 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10138 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10139 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 10140 assert(Conv.isBad()); 10141 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 10142 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10143 10144 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 10145 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 10146 // conversion-slot index. 10147 bool isObjectArgument = false; 10148 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10149 if (I == 0) 10150 isObjectArgument = true; 10151 else 10152 I--; 10153 } 10154 10155 std::string FnDesc; 10156 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10157 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(), 10158 FnDesc); 10159 10160 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 10161 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 10162 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 10163 10164 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 10165 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 10166 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 10167 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 10168 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10169 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 10170 10171 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 10172 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10173 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 10174 << Name << I + 1; 10175 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10176 return; 10177 } 10178 10179 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 10180 // to a qualifier mismatch. 10181 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 10182 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 10183 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10184 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 10185 else { 10186 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 10187 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10188 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10189 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 10190 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 10191 } 10192 } 10193 10194 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 10195 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 10196 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10197 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10198 10199 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 10200 if (isObjectArgument) 10201 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this) 10202 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10203 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10204 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace(); 10205 else 10206 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 10207 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10208 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10209 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 10210 << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1; 10211 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10212 return; 10213 } 10214 10215 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10216 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 10217 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10218 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10219 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 10220 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10221 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10222 return; 10223 } 10224 10225 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 10226 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 10227 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10228 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10229 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 10230 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10231 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10232 return; 10233 } 10234 10235 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 10236 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 10237 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10238 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10239 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 10240 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10241 return; 10242 } 10243 10244 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 10245 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 10246 10247 if (isObjectArgument) { 10248 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 10249 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10250 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10251 << (CVR - 1); 10252 } else { 10253 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 10254 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10255 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10256 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 10257 } 10258 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10259 return; 10260 } 10261 10262 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 10263 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 10264 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 10265 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 10266 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10267 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10268 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10269 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10270 return; 10271 } 10272 10273 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 10274 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 10275 // the failure. 10276 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 10277 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10278 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 10279 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 10280 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10281 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 10282 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10283 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10284 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10285 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10286 10287 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10288 return; 10289 } 10290 10291 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 10292 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 10293 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10294 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10295 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10296 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10297 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10298 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10299 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 10300 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 10301 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 10302 } 10303 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 10304 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 10305 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 10306 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 10307 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10308 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10309 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10310 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10311 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 10312 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 10313 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10314 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 10315 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 10316 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10317 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 10318 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 10319 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 10320 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 10321 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 10322 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 10323 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10324 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10325 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10326 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10327 return; 10328 } 10329 } 10330 10331 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 10332 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 10333 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10334 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10335 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 10336 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10337 return; 10338 } 10339 10340 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 10341 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 10342 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10343 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10344 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10345 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 10346 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10347 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10348 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10349 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10350 return; 10351 } 10352 } 10353 10354 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 10355 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 10356 return; 10357 10358 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10359 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 10360 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10361 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10362 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10363 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10364 10365 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 10366 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 10367 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 10368 FDiag << *HI; 10369 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 10370 10371 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10372 } 10373 10374 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 10375 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 10376 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 10377 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10378 unsigned NumArgs) { 10379 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10380 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10381 10382 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 10383 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 10384 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 10385 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 10386 // Just don't report anything. 10387 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 10388 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 10389 return true; 10390 10391 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 10392 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 10393 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10394 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 10395 } else { 10396 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 10397 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10398 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 10399 } 10400 10401 return false; 10402 } 10403 10404 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 10405 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 10406 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10407 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 10408 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 10409 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 10410 " or too few arguments"); 10411 10412 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10413 10414 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 10415 const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10416 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10417 10418 // at least / at most / exactly 10419 unsigned mode, modeCount; 10420 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 10421 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 10422 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 10423 mode = 0; // "at least" 10424 else 10425 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10426 modeCount = MinParams; 10427 } else { 10428 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 10429 mode = 1; // "at most" 10430 else 10431 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10432 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 10433 } 10434 10435 std::string Description; 10436 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10437 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description); 10438 10439 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 10440 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 10441 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10442 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 10443 else 10444 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 10445 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10446 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 10447 10448 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10449 } 10450 10451 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 10452 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10453 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10454 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 10455 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 10456 } 10457 10458 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 10459 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 10460 return TD; 10461 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 10462 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 10463 } 10464 10465 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 10466 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 10467 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 10468 unsigned NumArgs, 10469 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10470 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 10471 NamedDecl *ParamD; 10472 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 10473 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 10474 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 10475 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 10476 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10477 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10478 10479 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 10480 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10481 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10482 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 10483 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10484 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10485 return; 10486 } 10487 10488 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: { 10489 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10490 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10491 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack) 10492 << ParamD->getDeclName() 10493 << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1) 10494 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10495 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10496 return; 10497 } 10498 10499 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 10500 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 10501 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 10502 10503 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 10504 10505 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 10506 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 10507 QualifierCollector Qs; 10508 Qs.strip(Param); 10509 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 10510 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 10511 10512 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 10513 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 10514 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 10515 // done on dependent types). 10516 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 10517 10518 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 10519 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 10520 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10521 return; 10522 } 10523 10524 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 10525 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 10526 int which = 0; 10527 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10528 which = 0; 10529 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 10530 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 10531 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 10532 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 10533 QualType T1 = 10534 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10535 QualType T2 = 10536 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10537 if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 10538 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10539 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 10540 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 10541 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 10542 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10543 return; 10544 } 10545 10546 which = 1; 10547 } else { 10548 which = 2; 10549 } 10550 10551 // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of 10552 // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that 10553 // includes additional useful information. 10554 if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10555 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10556 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() != 10557 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) { 10558 which = 3; 10559 } 10560 10561 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10562 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 10563 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 10564 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10565 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10566 return; 10567 } 10568 10569 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10570 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 10571 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 10572 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10573 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 10574 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10575 else { 10576 int index = 0; 10577 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10578 index = TTP->getIndex(); 10579 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 10580 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10581 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 10582 else 10583 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 10584 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10585 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 10586 << (index + 1); 10587 } 10588 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10589 return; 10590 10591 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 10592 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10593 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10594 TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList(); 10595 TemplateArgString = " "; 10596 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10597 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10598 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10599 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10600 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10601 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints) 10602 << TemplateArgString; 10603 10604 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint( 10605 static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction); 10606 return; 10607 } 10608 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10609 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10610 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 10611 return; 10612 10613 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10614 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10615 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 10616 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10617 return; 10618 10619 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 10620 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10621 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10622 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10623 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10624 TemplateArgString = " "; 10625 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10626 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10627 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10628 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10629 } 10630 10631 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 10632 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 10633 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10634 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 10635 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 10636 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 10637 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 10638 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 10639 return; 10640 } 10641 10642 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 10643 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10644 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 10645 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10646 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 10647 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 10648 return; 10649 } 10650 10651 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 10652 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 10653 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10654 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10655 SourceRange R; 10656 if (PDiag) { 10657 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10658 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10659 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10660 } 10661 10662 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10663 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10664 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10665 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10666 return; 10667 } 10668 10669 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10670 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10671 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10672 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10673 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10674 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10675 TemplateArgString = " "; 10676 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10677 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10678 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10679 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10680 } 10681 10682 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10683 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10684 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10685 << TemplateArgString 10686 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10687 break; 10688 } 10689 10690 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10691 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10692 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10693 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10694 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10695 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10696 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10697 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10698 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10699 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10700 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10701 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10702 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10703 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10704 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10705 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10706 // name for types, not decls. 10707 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10708 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10709 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10710 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10711 return; 10712 } 10713 } 10714 } 10715 10716 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10717 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10718 return; 10719 10720 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10721 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10722 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10723 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10724 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10725 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10726 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10727 return; 10728 } 10729 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10730 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10731 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10732 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10733 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10734 return; 10735 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10736 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10737 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10738 return; 10739 } 10740 } 10741 10742 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10743 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10744 unsigned NumArgs, 10745 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10746 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10747 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10748 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10749 return; 10750 } 10751 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10752 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 10753 } 10754 10755 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 10756 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10757 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 10758 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10759 10760 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 10761 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 10762 10763 std::string FnDesc; 10764 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10765 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, 10766 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 10767 10768 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 10769 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 10770 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 10771 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 10772 10773 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 10774 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 10775 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 10776 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 10777 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 10778 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 10779 10780 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 10781 default: 10782 return; 10783 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 10784 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 10785 break; 10786 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 10787 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 10788 break; 10789 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 10790 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 10791 break; 10792 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 10793 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 10794 break; 10795 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 10796 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 10797 break; 10798 }; 10799 10800 bool ConstRHS = false; 10801 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 10802 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 10803 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10804 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 10805 } 10806 } 10807 10808 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 10809 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 10810 /* Diagnose */ true); 10811 } 10812 } 10813 10814 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10815 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10816 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 10817 10818 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10819 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 10820 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 10821 } 10822 10823 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10824 ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function); 10825 assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate"); 10826 10827 unsigned Kind; 10828 switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) { 10829 case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor: 10830 Kind = 0; 10831 break; 10832 case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion: 10833 Kind = 1; 10834 break; 10835 case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide: 10836 Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2; 10837 break; 10838 default: 10839 llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl"); 10840 } 10841 10842 // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration 10843 // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the 10844 // 'explicit' specifier. 10845 // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes. 10846 FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl(); 10847 if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) 10848 First = Pattern->getFirstDecl(); 10849 10850 S.Diag(First->getLocation(), 10851 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit) 10852 << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0) 10853 << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10854 } 10855 10856 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10857 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10858 10859 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10860 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension) 10861 << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee); 10862 } 10863 10864 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 10865 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 10866 /// 10867 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 10868 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 10869 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 10870 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 10871 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 10872 /// overload. 10873 /// 10874 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 10875 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 10876 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 10877 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor 10878 /// candidates only). 10879 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10880 unsigned NumArgs, 10881 bool TakingCandidateAddress, 10882 LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) { 10883 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10884 10885 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 10886 if (Cand->Viable) { 10887 if (Fn->isDeleted()) { 10888 std::string FnDesc; 10889 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10890 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 10891 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 10892 10893 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 10894 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10895 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 10896 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10897 return; 10898 } 10899 10900 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 10901 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 10902 return; 10903 } 10904 10905 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 10906 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 10907 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 10908 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 10909 10910 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 10911 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 10912 TakingCandidateAddress); 10913 10914 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 10915 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 10916 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 10917 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10918 return; 10919 } 10920 10921 case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: { 10922 Qualifiers QualsForPrinting; 10923 QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS); 10924 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 10925 diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch) 10926 << QualsForPrinting; 10927 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10928 return; 10929 } 10930 10931 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 10932 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 10933 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 10934 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 10935 10936 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 10937 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 10938 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 10939 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 10940 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 10941 10942 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 10943 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 10944 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 10945 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 10946 } 10947 10948 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 10949 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 10950 10951 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 10952 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 10953 10954 case ovl_fail_explicit: 10955 return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand); 10956 10957 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 10958 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 10959 10960 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 10961 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 10962 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 10963 return; 10964 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 10965 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 10966 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 10967 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 10968 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10969 return; 10970 10971 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 10972 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 10973 (void)Available; 10974 assert(!Available); 10975 break; 10976 } 10977 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 10978 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 10979 break; 10980 10981 case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: { 10982 std::string FnDesc; 10983 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10984 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 10985 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 10986 10987 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 10988 diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied) 10989 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 10990 << FnDesc /* Ignored */; 10991 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 10992 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction)) 10993 break; 10994 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 10995 } 10996 } 10997 } 10998 10999 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11000 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 11001 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 11002 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 11003 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 11004 bool isLValueReference = false; 11005 bool isRValueReference = false; 11006 bool isPointer = false; 11007 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11008 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 11009 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11010 isLValueReference = true; 11011 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11012 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 11013 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11014 isRValueReference = true; 11015 } 11016 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 11017 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11018 isPointer = true; 11019 } 11020 // Desugar down to a function type. 11021 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 11022 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 11023 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 11024 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 11025 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 11026 11027 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 11028 << FnType; 11029 } 11030 11031 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 11032 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11033 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11034 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 11035 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 11036 TypeStr += Opc; 11037 TypeStr += "("; 11038 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 11039 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 11040 TypeStr += ")"; 11041 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11042 } else { 11043 TypeStr += ", "; 11044 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 11045 TypeStr += ")"; 11046 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11047 } 11048 } 11049 11050 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11051 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11052 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 11053 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 11054 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 11055 11056 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 11057 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 11058 } 11059 } 11060 11061 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11062 if (Cand->Function) 11063 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 11064 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11065 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 11066 return SourceLocation(); 11067 } 11068 11069 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 11070 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 11071 case Sema::TDK_Success: 11072 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 11073 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 11074 11075 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 11076 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 11077 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 11078 return 1; 11079 11080 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 11081 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 11082 return 2; 11083 11084 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 11085 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 11086 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 11087 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 11088 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 11089 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 11090 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 11091 return 3; 11092 11093 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 11094 return 4; 11095 11096 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 11097 return 5; 11098 11099 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 11100 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 11101 return 6; 11102 } 11103 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 11104 } 11105 11106 namespace { 11107 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 11108 Sema &S; 11109 SourceLocation Loc; 11110 size_t NumArgs; 11111 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 11112 11113 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 11114 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 11115 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 11116 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 11117 11118 OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const { 11119 // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we 11120 // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else. 11121 if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11122 C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11123 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11124 11125 if (C->Function) { 11126 if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic()) 11127 return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11128 if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments()) 11129 return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 11130 } 11131 11132 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11133 } 11134 11135 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 11136 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 11137 // Fast-path this check. 11138 if (L == R) return false; 11139 11140 // Order first by viability. 11141 if (L->Viable) { 11142 if (!R->Viable) return true; 11143 11144 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 11145 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 11146 // that could exploit it. 11147 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11148 return true; 11149 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11150 return false; 11151 } else if (R->Viable) 11152 return false; 11153 11154 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 11155 11156 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 11157 if (!L->Viable) { 11158 OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L); 11159 OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R); 11160 11161 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 11162 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11163 LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11164 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11165 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11166 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11167 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11168 if (LDist == RDist) { 11169 if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind) 11170 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 11171 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 11172 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 11173 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 11174 // than there were arguments given. 11175 return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11176 } 11177 return LDist < RDist; 11178 } 11179 return false; 11180 } 11181 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11182 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11183 return true; 11184 11185 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 11186 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 11187 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 11188 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11189 return true; 11190 11191 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 11192 // comes first. 11193 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11194 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11195 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 11196 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 11197 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 11198 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 11199 } 11200 11201 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 11202 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 11203 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 11204 11205 int leftBetter = 0; 11206 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 11207 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 11208 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 11209 L->Conversions[I], 11210 R->Conversions[I])) { 11211 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 11212 leftBetter++; 11213 break; 11214 11215 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 11216 leftBetter--; 11217 break; 11218 11219 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 11220 break; 11221 } 11222 } 11223 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 11224 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 11225 11226 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11227 return false; 11228 11229 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 11230 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11231 return true; 11232 11233 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11234 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 11235 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11236 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11237 return false; 11238 11239 // TODO: others? 11240 } 11241 11242 // Sort everything else by location. 11243 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11244 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11245 11246 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11247 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 11248 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 11249 11250 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11251 } 11252 }; 11253 } 11254 11255 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 11256 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 11257 /// possible. 11258 static void 11259 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11260 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11261 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) { 11262 assert(!Cand->Viable); 11263 11264 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 11265 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11266 return; 11267 11268 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 11269 bool Unfixable = false; 11270 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 11271 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 11272 11273 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 11274 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 11275 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 11276 ++ConvIdx) { 11277 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 11278 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 11279 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 11280 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11281 break; 11282 } 11283 } 11284 11285 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 11286 // operation somehow. 11287 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 11288 11289 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 11290 unsigned ArgIdx = 0; 11291 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 11292 bool Reversed = Cand->RewriteKind & CRK_Reversed; 11293 11294 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11295 QualType ConvType 11296 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11297 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11298 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11299 ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11300 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11301 ConvIdx = 1; 11302 } else if (Cand->Function) { 11303 ParamTypes = 11304 Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11305 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 11306 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) { 11307 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11308 ConvIdx = 1; 11309 if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 11310 Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call) 11311 // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11312 ArgIdx = 1; 11313 } 11314 } else { 11315 // Builtin operator. 11316 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 11317 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 11318 } 11319 11320 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 11321 for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0; 11322 ConvIdx != ConvCount; 11323 ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) { 11324 assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion"); 11325 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 11326 // We've already checked this conversion. 11327 } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 11328 if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType()) 11329 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 11330 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 11331 else { 11332 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 11333 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx], 11334 SuppressUserConversions, 11335 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 11336 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 11337 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 11338 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 11339 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 11340 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11341 } 11342 } else 11343 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 11344 } 11345 } 11346 11347 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates( 11348 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11349 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11350 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11351 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 11352 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 11353 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 11354 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 11355 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11356 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 11357 continue; 11358 switch (OCD) { 11359 case OCD_AllCandidates: 11360 if (!Cand->Viable) { 11361 if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11362 // This a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 11363 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11364 continue; 11365 } 11366 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind); 11367 } 11368 break; 11369 11370 case OCD_ViableCandidates: 11371 if (!Cand->Viable) 11372 continue; 11373 break; 11374 11375 case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates: 11376 if (!Cand->Best) 11377 continue; 11378 break; 11379 } 11380 11381 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11382 } 11383 11384 llvm::stable_sort( 11385 Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 11386 11387 return Cands; 11388 } 11389 11390 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 11391 /// candidates in the candidate set. 11392 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt PD, 11393 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11394 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11395 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11396 11397 auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter); 11398 11399 S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second); 11400 11401 NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc); 11402 11403 if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates) 11404 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()}); 11405 } 11406 11407 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11408 ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands, 11409 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11410 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 11411 11412 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11413 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11414 auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); 11415 for (; I != E; ++I) { 11416 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 11417 11418 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 11419 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11420 // candidate list. 11421 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 11422 break; 11423 } 11424 ++CandsShown; 11425 11426 if (Cand->Function) 11427 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 11428 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS); 11429 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11430 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 11431 else { 11432 assert(Cand->Viable && 11433 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11434 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 11435 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 11436 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 11437 // 11438 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 11439 // different ambiguities, though. 11440 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 11441 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 11442 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 11443 } 11444 11445 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 11446 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 11447 } 11448 } 11449 11450 if (I != E) 11451 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11452 } 11453 11454 static SourceLocation 11455 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 11456 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 11457 : SourceLocation(); 11458 } 11459 11460 namespace { 11461 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 11462 Sema &S; 11463 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 11464 11465 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 11466 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 11467 // Fast-path this check. 11468 if (L == R) 11469 return false; 11470 11471 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 11472 11473 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 11474 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11475 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 11476 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11477 11478 // Sort everything else by location. 11479 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11480 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11481 11482 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11483 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 11484 return false; 11485 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 11486 return true; 11487 11488 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11489 } 11490 }; 11491 } 11492 11493 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 11494 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 11495 /// deductions. 11496 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 11497 bool ForTakingAddress) { 11498 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 11499 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 11500 } 11501 11502 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 11503 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 11504 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 11505 } 11506 } 11507 11508 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 11509 destroyCandidates(); 11510 Candidates.clear(); 11511 } 11512 11513 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 11514 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 11515 /// the candidate set. 11516 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 11517 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 11518 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 11519 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 11520 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 11521 // and sort those. 11522 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 11523 Cands.reserve(size()); 11524 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11525 if (Cand->Specialization) 11526 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11527 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 11528 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11529 } 11530 11531 llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 11532 11533 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 11534 // for generalization purposes (?). 11535 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11536 11537 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 11538 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11539 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11540 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 11541 11542 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 11543 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11544 // candidate list. 11545 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 11546 break; 11547 ++CandsShown; 11548 11549 assert(Cand->Specialization && 11550 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11551 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 11552 } 11553 11554 if (I != E) 11555 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11556 } 11557 11558 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 11559 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 11560 // R (A) --> R(A) 11561 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 11562 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 11563 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 11564 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 11565 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 11566 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 11567 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11568 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11569 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 11570 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11571 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11572 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 11573 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11574 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11575 Ret = 11576 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 11577 return Ret; 11578 } 11579 11580 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 11581 bool Complain = true) { 11582 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 11583 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 11584 return true; 11585 11586 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11587 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 11588 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 11589 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 11590 return true; 11591 11592 return false; 11593 } 11594 11595 namespace { 11596 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 11597 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 11598 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 11599 Sema& S; 11600 Expr* SourceExpr; 11601 const QualType& TargetType; 11602 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 11603 11604 bool Complain; 11605 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 11606 ASTContext& Context; 11607 11608 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 11609 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 11610 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11611 bool HasComplained; 11612 11613 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 11614 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 11615 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 11616 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 11617 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 11618 11619 public: 11620 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 11621 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 11622 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 11623 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 11624 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 11625 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 11626 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 11627 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 11628 HasComplained(false), 11629 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 11630 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 11631 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 11632 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 11633 11634 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 11635 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 11636 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 11637 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 11638 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 11639 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11640 DeclAccessPair dap; 11641 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11642 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 11643 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 11644 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11645 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 11646 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 11647 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 11648 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 11649 11650 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 11651 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 11652 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 11653 return; 11654 } 11655 11656 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 11657 } 11658 return; 11659 } 11660 11661 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11662 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 11663 11664 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 11665 // C++ [over.over]p4: 11666 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 11667 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 11668 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 11669 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 11670 else 11671 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 11672 } 11673 } 11674 11675 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 11676 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 11677 } 11678 11679 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 11680 11681 private: 11682 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 11683 QualType Discard; 11684 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 11685 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 11686 } 11687 11688 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 11689 /// desired type than B. 11690 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 11691 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 11692 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 11693 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 11694 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 11695 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 11696 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 11697 } 11698 11699 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 11700 /// false otherwise. 11701 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 11702 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 11703 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 11704 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 11705 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 11706 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 11707 Best = I; 11708 11709 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 11710 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 11711 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 11712 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 11713 }; 11714 11715 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 11716 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 11717 if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 11718 return false; 11719 Matches[0] = *Best; 11720 Matches.resize(1); 11721 return true; 11722 } 11723 11724 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 11725 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 11726 } 11727 11728 // [ToType] [Return] 11729 11730 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11731 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11732 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 11733 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 11734 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 11735 } 11736 11737 // return true if any matching specializations were found 11738 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 11739 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 11740 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 11741 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 11742 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 11743 // static when converting to member pointer. 11744 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11745 return false; 11746 } 11747 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11748 return false; 11749 11750 // C++ [over.over]p2: 11751 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 11752 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 11753 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 11754 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 11755 // overloaded functions considered. 11756 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 11757 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 11758 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 11759 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 11760 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 11761 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 11762 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 11763 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 11764 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 11765 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 11766 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 11767 return false; 11768 } 11769 11770 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 11771 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 11772 // This function template specicalization works. 11773 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 11774 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 11775 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 11776 11777 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 11778 return false; 11779 11780 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 11781 return true; 11782 } 11783 11784 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 11785 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 11786 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 11787 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 11788 // when converting to member pointer. 11789 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11790 return false; 11791 } 11792 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11793 return false; 11794 11795 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 11796 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 11797 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 11798 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 11799 return false; 11800 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 11801 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11802 if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 11803 return false; 11804 } 11805 11806 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 11807 // now. 11808 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), 11809 Complain)) { 11810 HasComplained |= Complain; 11811 return false; 11812 } 11813 11814 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 11815 return false; 11816 11817 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 11818 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 11819 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 11820 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 11821 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 11822 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 11823 return true; 11824 } 11825 } 11826 11827 return false; 11828 } 11829 11830 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 11831 bool Ret = false; 11832 11833 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 11834 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 11835 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 11836 return false; 11837 11838 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 11839 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 11840 I != E; ++I) { 11841 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 11842 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 11843 11844 // C++ [over.over]p3: 11845 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 11846 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 11847 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 11848 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 11849 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 11850 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 11851 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 11852 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 11853 Ret = true; 11854 } 11855 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 11856 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 11857 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 11858 Ret = true; 11859 } 11860 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 11861 return Ret; 11862 } 11863 11864 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 11865 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 11866 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 11867 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 11868 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 11869 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 11870 11871 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 11872 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 11873 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 11874 // best function template (if it exists). 11875 11876 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 11877 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 11878 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 11879 11880 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 11881 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 11882 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 11883 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 11884 SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(), 11885 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11886 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 11887 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 11888 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 11889 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 11890 11891 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 11892 // Make it the first and only element 11893 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 11894 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 11895 Matches.resize(1); 11896 } else 11897 HasComplained |= Complain; 11898 } 11899 11900 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 11901 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 11902 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 11903 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 11904 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 11905 ++I; 11906 else { 11907 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 11908 Matches.resize(N); 11909 } 11910 } 11911 } 11912 11913 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 11914 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 11915 } 11916 11917 public: 11918 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 11919 assert(Matches.empty()); 11920 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 11921 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 11922 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11923 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 11924 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 11925 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11926 else { 11927 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 11928 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 11929 // normally. 11930 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 11931 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 11932 I != IEnd; ++I) 11933 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 11934 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 11935 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 11936 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType, 11937 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11938 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc()); 11939 } 11940 } 11941 11942 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 11943 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 11944 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 11945 } 11946 11947 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 11948 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 11949 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 11950 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 11951 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 11952 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11953 } 11954 11955 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 11956 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11957 } 11958 11959 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 11960 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), 11961 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11962 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11963 } 11964 11965 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 11966 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 11967 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 11968 } 11969 11970 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 11971 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 11972 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11973 << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11974 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 11975 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11976 } 11977 11978 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 11979 11980 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 11981 11982 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 11983 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11984 return Matches[0].second; 11985 } 11986 11987 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 11988 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11989 return &Matches[0].first; 11990 } 11991 }; 11992 } 11993 11994 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 11995 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 11996 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 11997 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 11998 /// 11999 /// @code 12000 /// int f(double); 12001 /// int f(int); 12002 /// 12003 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 12004 /// @endcode 12005 /// 12006 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 12007 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 12008 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 12009 FunctionDecl * 12010 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 12011 QualType TargetType, 12012 bool Complain, 12013 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 12014 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 12015 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12016 12017 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 12018 Complain); 12019 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 12020 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 12021 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 12022 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 12023 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12024 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 12025 else 12026 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 12027 } 12028 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 12029 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 12030 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 12031 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 12032 assert(Fn); 12033 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12034 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 12035 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 12036 if (Complain) { 12037 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 12038 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 12039 else 12040 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 12041 } 12042 } 12043 12044 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 12045 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 12046 return Fn; 12047 } 12048 12049 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12050 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 12051 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 12052 /// 12053 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload 12054 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate 12055 /// that is more constrained than the rest. 12056 FunctionDecl * 12057 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 12058 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 12059 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 12060 bool IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12061 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 12062 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12063 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls; 12064 12065 auto CheckMoreConstrained = 12066 [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> { 12067 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2; 12068 FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1); 12069 FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2); 12070 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 12071 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1)) 12072 return None; 12073 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 12074 return None; 12075 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2) 12076 return None; 12077 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 12078 }; 12079 12080 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 12081 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 12082 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 12083 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12084 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12085 if (!FD) 12086 return nullptr; 12087 12088 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 12089 continue; 12090 12091 // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the 12092 // previous one. 12093 if (Result) { 12094 Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD, 12095 Result); 12096 if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) { 12097 IsResultAmbiguous = true; 12098 AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD); 12099 continue; 12100 } 12101 if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) 12102 continue; 12103 // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it. 12104 } 12105 IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12106 DAP = I.getPair(); 12107 Result = FD; 12108 } 12109 12110 if (IsResultAmbiguous) 12111 return nullptr; 12112 12113 if (Result) { 12114 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC; 12115 // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with 12116 // the selected result. 12117 for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls) 12118 if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue()) 12119 return nullptr; 12120 Pair = DAP; 12121 } 12122 return Result; 12123 } 12124 12125 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 12126 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This 12127 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 12128 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 12129 /// 12130 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails. 12131 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 12132 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate( 12133 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 12134 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 12135 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 12136 12137 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12138 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 12139 if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 12140 Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) 12141 return false; 12142 12143 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 12144 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 12145 // for both. 12146 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 12147 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 12148 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 12149 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12150 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 12151 else 12152 SrcExpr = Fixed; 12153 return true; 12154 } 12155 12156 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12157 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 12158 /// 12159 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 12160 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 12161 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 12162 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 12163 /// 12164 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 12165 /// returned. 12166 FunctionDecl * 12167 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 12168 bool Complain, 12169 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 12170 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12171 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 12172 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 12173 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12174 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 12175 // operator. 12176 12177 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 12178 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 12179 return nullptr; 12180 12181 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 12182 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12183 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 12184 12185 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 12186 // whose type matches exactly. 12187 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 12188 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 12189 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12190 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 12191 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 12192 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 12193 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 12194 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 12195 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 12196 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12197 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12198 12199 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12200 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12201 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12202 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12203 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12204 // overloaded functions considered. 12205 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12206 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12207 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 12208 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12209 Specialization, Info, 12210 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12211 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12212 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 12213 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12214 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12215 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12216 continue; 12217 } 12218 12219 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 12220 12221 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 12222 if (Matched) { 12223 if (Complain) { 12224 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12225 << ovl->getName(); 12226 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 12227 } 12228 return nullptr; 12229 } 12230 12231 Matched = Specialization; 12232 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 12233 } 12234 12235 if (Matched && 12236 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 12237 return nullptr; 12238 12239 return Matched; 12240 } 12241 12242 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 12243 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 12244 // 12245 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 12246 // 12247 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 12248 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 12249 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 12250 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12251 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 12252 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 12253 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 12254 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 12255 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12256 12257 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 12258 12259 DeclAccessPair found; 12260 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 12261 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12262 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 12263 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) { 12264 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12265 return true; 12266 } 12267 12268 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 12269 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 12270 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 12271 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 12272 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 12273 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 12274 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 12275 if (!complain) return false; 12276 12277 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 12278 diag::err_bound_member_function) 12279 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 12280 12281 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 12282 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 12283 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 12284 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 12285 // the static candidates were rejected. 12286 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12287 return true; 12288 } 12289 12290 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 12291 SingleFunctionExpression = 12292 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 12293 12294 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 12295 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 12296 SingleFunctionExpression = 12297 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 12298 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 12299 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12300 return true; 12301 } 12302 } 12303 } 12304 12305 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 12306 if (complain) { 12307 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 12308 << ovl.Expression->getName() 12309 << DestTypeForComplaining 12310 << OpRangeForComplaining 12311 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 12312 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 12313 12314 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12315 return true; 12316 } 12317 12318 return false; 12319 } 12320 12321 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 12322 return true; 12323 } 12324 12325 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 12326 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 12327 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 12328 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12329 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12330 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12331 bool PartialOverloading, 12332 bool KnownValid) { 12333 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 12334 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 12335 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 12336 12337 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 12338 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 12339 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 12340 return; 12341 } 12342 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 12343 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 12344 return; 12345 12346 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 12347 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12348 PartialOverloading); 12349 return; 12350 } 12351 12352 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 12353 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 12354 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 12355 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 12356 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12357 PartialOverloading); 12358 return; 12359 } 12360 12361 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 12362 } 12363 12364 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 12365 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 12366 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12367 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12368 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12369 bool PartialOverloading) { 12370 12371 #ifndef NDEBUG 12372 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 12373 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 12374 // 12375 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 12376 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 12377 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 12378 // 12379 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 12380 // 12381 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 12382 // using-declaration, or 12383 // 12384 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 12385 // template 12386 // 12387 // then Y is empty. 12388 12389 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12390 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12391 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12392 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 12393 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 12394 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 12395 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 12396 } 12397 } 12398 #endif 12399 12400 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 12401 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12402 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12403 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12404 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12405 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12406 } 12407 12408 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12409 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 12410 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12411 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 12412 /*KnownValid*/ true); 12413 12414 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 12415 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 12416 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12417 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 12418 } 12419 12420 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 12421 /// a different namespace. 12422 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 12423 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 12424 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 12425 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 12426 return false; 12427 12428 default: 12429 return true; 12430 } 12431 } 12432 12433 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 12434 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 12435 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 12436 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 12437 /// 12438 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12439 static bool 12440 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 12441 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 12442 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 12443 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12444 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12445 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 12446 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 12447 return false; 12448 12449 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 12450 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 12451 continue; 12452 12453 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 12454 12455 if (!R.empty()) { 12456 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12457 12458 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 12459 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 12460 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 12461 R.clear(); 12462 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 12463 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 12464 return false; 12465 } 12466 12467 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 12468 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 12469 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 12470 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12471 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 12472 12473 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12474 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 12475 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 12476 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 12477 R.clear(); 12478 return false; 12479 } 12480 12481 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 12482 // declaring the function there instead. 12483 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 12484 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 12485 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 12486 AssociatedNamespaces, 12487 AssociatedClasses); 12488 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 12489 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 12490 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 12491 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 12492 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 12493 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 12494 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 12495 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 12496 continue; 12497 12498 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 12499 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 12500 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 12501 if (NS && 12502 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 12503 continue; 12504 12505 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 12506 } 12507 } 12508 12509 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12510 << R.getLookupName(); 12511 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 12512 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12513 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12514 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 12515 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 12516 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12517 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12518 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 12519 } else { 12520 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 12521 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 12522 // a localized representation of a list of items. 12523 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12524 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12525 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 12526 } 12527 12528 // Try to recover by calling this function. 12529 return true; 12530 } 12531 12532 R.clear(); 12533 } 12534 12535 return false; 12536 } 12537 12538 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 12539 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 12540 /// was defined. 12541 /// 12542 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12543 static bool 12544 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 12545 SourceLocation OpLoc, 12546 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 12547 DeclarationName OpName = 12548 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12549 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 12550 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 12551 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 12552 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 12553 } 12554 12555 namespace { 12556 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 12557 Sema &SemaRef; 12558 public: 12559 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 12560 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 12561 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 12562 } 12563 12564 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 12565 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 12566 } 12567 }; 12568 12569 } 12570 12571 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 12572 /// 12573 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 12574 static ExprResult 12575 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12576 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12577 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12578 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12579 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12580 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12581 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 12582 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 12583 // 12584 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 12585 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 12586 // 12587 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 12588 return ExprError(); 12589 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 12590 12591 CXXScopeSpec SS; 12592 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 12593 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 12594 12595 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12596 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12597 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12598 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12599 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12600 } 12601 12602 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 12603 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 12604 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 12605 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup( 12606 SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 12607 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)) { 12608 NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{}; 12609 FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(), 12610 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, 12611 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn)); 12612 CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator = 12613 AllowTypoCorrection 12614 ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator) 12615 : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator); 12616 if (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || 12617 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12618 Args)) 12619 return ExprError(); 12620 } 12621 12622 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 12623 12624 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 12625 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 12626 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12627 return ExprError(); 12628 } 12629 12630 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 12631 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 12632 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 12633 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 12634 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 12635 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 12636 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 12637 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 12638 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12639 else 12640 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 12641 12642 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12643 return ExprError(); 12644 12645 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 12646 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 12647 // end up here. 12648 return SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 12649 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 12650 RParenLoc); 12651 } 12652 12653 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 12654 /// the given function. 12655 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 12656 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12657 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12658 MultiExprArg Args, 12659 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12660 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12661 ExprResult *Result) { 12662 #ifndef NDEBUG 12663 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12664 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 12665 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 12666 12667 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 12668 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 12669 FunctionDecl *F; 12670 if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() && 12671 ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 12672 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 12673 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 12674 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 12675 12676 // We don't perform ADL in C. 12677 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 12678 } 12679 #endif 12680 12681 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12682 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 12683 *Result = ExprError(); 12684 return true; 12685 } 12686 12687 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 12688 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 12689 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 12690 12691 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 12692 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 12693 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 12694 12695 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12696 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 12697 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) == 12698 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 12699 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function 12700 // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name 12701 // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent 12702 // base classes. 12703 CallExpr *CE = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, 12704 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 12705 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 12706 CE->setValueDependent(true); 12707 CE->setInstantiationDependent(true); 12708 *Result = CE; 12709 return true; 12710 } 12711 } 12712 12713 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 12714 return false; 12715 12716 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12717 return false; 12718 } 12719 12720 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 12721 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 12722 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 12723 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12724 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12725 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12726 MultiExprArg Args, 12727 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12728 Expr *ExecConfig, 12729 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12730 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 12731 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 12732 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12733 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 12734 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 12735 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 12736 AllowTypoCorrection); 12737 12738 switch (OverloadResult) { 12739 case OR_Success: { 12740 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 12741 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 12742 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 12743 return ExprError(); 12744 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 12745 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 12746 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 12747 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 12748 } 12749 12750 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12751 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 12752 // have meant to call. 12753 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 12754 Args, RParenLoc, 12755 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 12756 AllowTypoCorrection); 12757 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 12758 return Recovery; 12759 12760 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 12761 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 12762 // emit better ones. 12763 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 12764 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12765 continue; 12766 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 12767 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12768 if (FD && 12769 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 12770 Arg->getExprLoc())) 12771 return ExprError(); 12772 } 12773 } 12774 12775 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12776 PartialDiagnosticAt( 12777 Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12778 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 12779 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12780 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12781 break; 12782 } 12783 12784 case OR_Ambiguous: 12785 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12786 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12787 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 12788 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12789 SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 12790 break; 12791 12792 case OR_Deleted: { 12793 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12794 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12795 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 12796 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12797 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12798 12799 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 12800 // the call in the AST. 12801 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 12802 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 12803 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 12804 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 12805 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 12806 } 12807 } 12808 12809 // Overload resolution failed. 12810 return ExprError(); 12811 } 12812 12813 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 12814 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 12815 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 12816 if (I->Viable && 12817 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 12818 I->Viable = false; 12819 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 12820 } 12821 } 12822 } 12823 12824 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 12825 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 12826 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 12827 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 12828 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 12829 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 12830 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12831 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12832 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12833 MultiExprArg Args, 12834 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12835 Expr *ExecConfig, 12836 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 12837 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 12838 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 12839 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 12840 ExprResult result; 12841 12842 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 12843 &result)) 12844 return result; 12845 12846 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 12847 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 12848 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 12849 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 12850 12851 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12852 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 12853 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 12854 12855 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 12856 ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best, 12857 OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection); 12858 } 12859 12860 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 12861 return Functions.size() > 1 || 12862 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 12863 } 12864 12865 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 12866 /// operator. 12867 /// 12868 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 12869 /// 12870 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 12871 /// 12872 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 12873 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 12874 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 12875 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 12876 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 12877 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 12878 /// 12879 /// \param Input The input argument. 12880 ExprResult 12881 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 12882 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 12883 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 12884 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12885 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 12886 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12887 // TODO: provide better source location info. 12888 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 12889 12890 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 12891 return ExprError(); 12892 12893 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 12894 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 12895 12896 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 12897 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 12898 // post-decrement. 12899 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 12900 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 12901 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 12902 SourceLocation()); 12903 NumArgs = 2; 12904 } 12905 12906 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 12907 12908 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 12909 if (Fns.empty()) 12910 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 12911 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false); 12912 12913 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12914 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 12915 Context, NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12916 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 12917 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, 12918 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 12919 FPOptions()); 12920 } 12921 12922 // Build an empty overload set. 12923 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12924 12925 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 12926 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12927 12928 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12929 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12930 12931 // Add candidates from ADL. 12932 if (PerformADL) { 12933 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 12934 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 12935 CandidateSet); 12936 } 12937 12938 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12939 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12940 12941 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12942 12943 // Perform overload resolution. 12944 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12945 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 12946 case OR_Success: { 12947 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12948 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12949 12950 if (FnDecl) { 12951 Expr *Base = nullptr; 12952 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12953 // operator. 12954 12955 // Convert the arguments. 12956 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12957 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 12958 12959 ExprResult InputRes = 12960 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12961 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12962 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 12963 return ExprError(); 12964 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 12965 } else { 12966 // Convert the arguments. 12967 ExprResult InputInit 12968 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 12969 Context, 12970 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12971 SourceLocation(), 12972 Input); 12973 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 12974 return ExprError(); 12975 Input = InputInit.get(); 12976 } 12977 12978 // Build the actual expression node. 12979 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 12980 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 12981 OpLoc); 12982 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12983 return ExprError(); 12984 12985 // Determine the result type. 12986 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12987 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12988 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12989 12990 Args[0] = Input; 12991 CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 12992 Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 12993 FPOptions(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 12994 12995 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 12996 return ExprError(); 12997 12998 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 12999 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13000 return ExprError(); 13001 13002 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13003 } else { 13004 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13005 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13006 // operator node. 13007 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 13008 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing, 13009 CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13010 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13011 return ExprError(); 13012 Input = InputRes.get(); 13013 break; 13014 } 13015 } 13016 13017 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13018 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13019 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13020 // defined too late to be candidates. 13021 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 13022 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13023 return ExprError(); 13024 13025 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 13026 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 13027 break; 13028 13029 case OR_Ambiguous: 13030 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13031 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, 13032 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13033 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13034 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()), 13035 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray, 13036 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 13037 return ExprError(); 13038 13039 case OR_Deleted: 13040 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13041 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13042 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13043 << Input->getSourceRange()), 13044 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13045 OpLoc); 13046 return ExprError(); 13047 } 13048 13049 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 13050 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 13051 // build a built-in operation. 13052 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13053 } 13054 13055 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator. 13056 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 13057 OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 13058 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13059 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) { 13060 SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation(); 13061 13062 OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = 13063 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates 13064 ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op) 13065 : OO_None; 13066 13067 // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the 13068 // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary. 13069 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 13070 13071 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13072 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13073 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op)) 13074 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 13075 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13076 13077 // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates. 13078 if (ExtraOp) { 13079 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13080 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp)) 13081 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 13082 CandidateSet, 13083 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13084 } 13085 13086 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 13087 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 13088 // which don't get here). 13089 if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) { 13090 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13091 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 13092 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13093 CandidateSet); 13094 if (ExtraOp) { 13095 DeclarationName ExtraOpName = 13096 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp); 13097 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args, 13098 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13099 CandidateSet); 13100 } 13101 } 13102 13103 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13104 // 13105 // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly 13106 // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate, 13107 // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example: 13108 // 13109 // enum class E { e }; 13110 // bool operator!=(E, E) requires false; 13111 // bool k = E::e != E::e; 13112 // 13113 // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But 13114 // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core 13115 // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement. 13116 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13117 } 13118 13119 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13120 /// operator. 13121 /// 13122 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 13123 /// 13124 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13125 /// 13126 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13127 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13128 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13129 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13130 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13131 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 13132 /// 13133 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 13134 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 13135 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL. 13136 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by 13137 /// C++20 operator rewrites. 13138 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function, 13139 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in 13140 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way 13141 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1. 13142 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13143 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13144 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, 13145 Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL, 13146 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates, 13147 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13148 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 13149 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 13150 13151 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a) 13152 AllowRewrittenCandidates = false; 13153 13154 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13155 13156 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13157 // expression. 13158 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13159 if (Fns.empty()) { 13160 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 13161 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 13162 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 13163 return new (Context) BinaryOperator( 13164 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13165 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 13166 13167 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 13168 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, 13169 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc, 13170 FPFeatures); 13171 } 13172 13173 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 13174 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13175 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 13176 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13177 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13178 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 13179 Context, NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 13180 /*ADL*/ PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 13181 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn, Args, 13182 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13183 FPFeatures); 13184 } 13185 13186 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 13187 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13188 return ExprError(); 13189 13190 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 13191 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 13192 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 13193 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13194 return ExprError(); 13195 13196 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 13197 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 13198 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 13199 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 13200 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 13201 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 13202 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13203 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13204 13205 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 13206 // create a built-in binary operator. 13207 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 13208 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13209 13210 // Build the overload set. 13211 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 13212 OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 13213 OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates)); 13214 if (DefaultedFn) 13215 CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn); 13216 LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL); 13217 13218 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13219 13220 // Perform overload resolution. 13221 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13222 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13223 case OR_Success: { 13224 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13225 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13226 13227 bool IsReversed = (Best->RewriteKind & CRK_Reversed); 13228 if (IsReversed) 13229 std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]); 13230 13231 if (FnDecl) { 13232 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13233 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13234 // operator. 13235 13236 OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp = 13237 FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator(); 13238 13239 // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9: 13240 // If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload 13241 // resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool 13242 if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && 13243 !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) { 13244 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool) 13245 << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13246 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13247 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 13248 return ExprError(); 13249 } 13250 13251 if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed && 13252 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ChosenOp)) { 13253 // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if the 13254 // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a 13255 // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is 13256 // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension. 13257 for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) { 13258 if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function == FnDecl && 13259 Cand.RewriteKind & CRK_Reversed) { 13260 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 13261 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 13262 *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx], 13263 Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) == 13264 ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) { 13265 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed) 13266 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13267 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 13268 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13269 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13270 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate); 13271 } 13272 } 13273 break; 13274 } 13275 } 13276 } 13277 13278 // Convert the arguments. 13279 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13280 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 13281 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13282 13283 ExprResult Arg1 = 13284 PerformCopyInitialization( 13285 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13286 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13287 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13288 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13289 return ExprError(); 13290 13291 ExprResult Arg0 = 13292 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13293 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13294 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13295 return ExprError(); 13296 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13297 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13298 } else { 13299 // Convert the arguments. 13300 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 13301 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13302 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13303 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 13304 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13305 return ExprError(); 13306 13307 ExprResult Arg1 = 13308 PerformCopyInitialization( 13309 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13310 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 13311 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13312 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13313 return ExprError(); 13314 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13315 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13316 } 13317 13318 // Build the actual expression node. 13319 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13320 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 13321 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13322 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13323 return ExprError(); 13324 13325 // Determine the result type. 13326 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13327 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13328 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13329 13330 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13331 Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13332 FPFeatures, Best->IsADLCandidate); 13333 13334 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 13335 FnDecl)) 13336 return ExprError(); 13337 13338 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 13339 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 13340 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 13341 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13342 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 13343 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 13344 } 13345 13346 // Check for a self move. 13347 if (Op == OO_Equal) 13348 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 13349 13350 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 13351 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 13352 VariadicDoesNotApply); 13353 13354 ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13355 if (R.isInvalid()) 13356 return ExprError(); 13357 13358 // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments 13359 // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now. 13360 if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) || 13361 (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) { 13362 if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) { 13363 assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name"); 13364 R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get()); 13365 } else { 13366 assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name"); 13367 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13368 Expr *ZeroLiteral = 13369 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc); 13370 13371 Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx; 13372 Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship; 13373 Ctx.Entity = FnDecl; 13374 pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx); 13375 13376 R = CreateOverloadedBinOp( 13377 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(), 13378 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL, 13379 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false); 13380 13381 popCodeSynthesisContext(); 13382 } 13383 if (R.isInvalid()) 13384 return ExprError(); 13385 } else { 13386 assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name"); 13387 } 13388 13389 // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting. 13390 if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None) 13391 R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed); 13392 13393 return R; 13394 } else { 13395 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13396 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13397 // operator node. 13398 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13399 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13400 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13401 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13402 return ExprError(); 13403 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13404 13405 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13406 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13407 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13408 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13409 return ExprError(); 13410 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13411 break; 13412 } 13413 } 13414 13415 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13416 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 13417 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 13418 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 13419 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 13420 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 13421 break; 13422 13423 // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way 13424 // compare result using '==' and '<'. 13425 if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) { 13426 ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0], 13427 Args[1], DefaultedFn); 13428 if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable()) 13429 return E; 13430 } 13431 13432 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 13433 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 13434 // no overloaded assignment operator found 13435 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 13436 StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 13437 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 13438 Args, OpLoc); 13439 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 13440 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 13441 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13442 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13443 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13444 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 13445 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 13446 << Args[0]->getType() 13447 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13448 } 13449 } else { 13450 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13451 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13452 // defined too late to be candidates. 13453 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 13454 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13455 return ExprError(); 13456 13457 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 13458 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 13459 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13460 } 13461 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 13462 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 13463 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc); 13464 return Result; 13465 } 13466 13467 case OR_Ambiguous: 13468 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13469 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13470 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13471 << Args[0]->getType() 13472 << Args[1]->getType() 13473 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13474 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13475 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13476 OpLoc); 13477 return ExprError(); 13478 13479 case OR_Deleted: 13480 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 13481 FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function; 13482 DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD); 13483 if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) { 13484 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 13485 << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember(); 13486 } else { 13487 assert(DFK.isComparison()); 13488 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison) 13489 << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD; 13490 } 13491 13492 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 13493 // explain why it's deleted. 13494 NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD); 13495 return ExprError(); 13496 } 13497 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13498 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13499 OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13500 << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName() 13501 .getCXXOverloadedOperator()) 13502 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13503 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13504 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13505 OpLoc); 13506 return ExprError(); 13507 } 13508 13509 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13510 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13511 } 13512 13513 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison( 13514 SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 13515 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13516 const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info = 13517 Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType()); 13518 // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't 13519 // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this. 13520 if (!Info) 13521 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13522 13523 // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to 13524 // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands. 13525 assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() && 13526 "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once"); 13527 Expr *OrigLHS = LHS; 13528 Expr *OrigRHS = RHS; 13529 13530 // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to 13531 // each of them multiple times below. 13532 LHS = new (Context) 13533 OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(), 13534 LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS); 13535 RHS = new (Context) 13536 OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(), 13537 RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS); 13538 13539 ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true, 13540 DefaultedFn); 13541 if (Eq.isInvalid()) 13542 return ExprError(); 13543 13544 ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, 13545 true, DefaultedFn); 13546 if (Less.isInvalid()) 13547 return ExprError(); 13548 13549 ExprResult Greater; 13550 if (Info->isPartial()) { 13551 Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true, 13552 DefaultedFn); 13553 if (Greater.isInvalid()) 13554 return ExprError(); 13555 } 13556 13557 // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform. 13558 struct Comparison { 13559 ExprResult Cmp; 13560 ComparisonCategoryResult Result; 13561 } Comparisons[4] = 13562 { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal 13563 : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent}, 13564 {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less}, 13565 {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater}, 13566 {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered}, 13567 }; 13568 13569 int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2; 13570 13571 // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions. 13572 ExprResult Result; 13573 for (; I >= 0; --I) { 13574 // Build a reference to the comparison category constant. 13575 auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result); 13576 // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this? 13577 if (!VI) 13578 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13579 ExprResult ThisResult = 13580 BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD); 13581 if (ThisResult.isInvalid()) 13582 return ExprError(); 13583 13584 // Build a conditional unless this is the final case. 13585 if (Result.get()) { 13586 Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(), 13587 ThisResult.get(), Result.get()); 13588 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13589 return ExprError(); 13590 } else { 13591 Result = ThisResult; 13592 } 13593 } 13594 13595 // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to 13596 // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used. 13597 Expr *SyntacticForm = new (Context) 13598 BinaryOperator(OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(), 13599 Result.get()->getValueKind(), 13600 Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc, FPFeatures); 13601 Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()}; 13602 return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2); 13603 } 13604 13605 ExprResult 13606 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 13607 SourceLocation RLoc, 13608 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 13609 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 13610 DeclarationName OpName = 13611 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 13612 13613 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13614 // expression. 13615 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13616 13617 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13618 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 13619 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13620 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 13621 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 13622 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 13623 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 13624 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 13625 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 13626 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 13627 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 13628 13629 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args, 13630 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, 13631 FPOptions()); 13632 } 13633 13634 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 13635 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13636 return ExprError(); 13637 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13638 return ExprError(); 13639 13640 // Build an empty overload set. 13641 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13642 13643 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 13644 13645 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13646 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13647 13648 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13649 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13650 13651 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13652 13653 // Perform overload resolution. 13654 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13655 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 13656 case OR_Success: { 13657 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13658 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13659 13660 if (FnDecl) { 13661 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13662 // operator. 13663 13664 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13665 13666 // Convert the arguments. 13667 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 13668 ExprResult Arg0 = 13669 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13670 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13671 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13672 return ExprError(); 13673 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 13674 13675 // Convert the arguments. 13676 ExprResult InputInit 13677 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13678 Context, 13679 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13680 SourceLocation(), 13681 Args[1]); 13682 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13683 return ExprError(); 13684 13685 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 13686 13687 // Build the actual expression node. 13688 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13689 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 13690 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13691 Best->FoundDecl, 13692 Base, 13693 HadMultipleCandidates, 13694 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 13695 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 13696 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13697 return ExprError(); 13698 13699 // Determine the result type 13700 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13701 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13702 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13703 13704 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 13705 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), 13706 Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc, FPOptions()); 13707 13708 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13709 return ExprError(); 13710 13711 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 13712 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13713 return ExprError(); 13714 13715 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13716 } else { 13717 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13718 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13719 // operator node. 13720 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13721 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13722 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13723 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13724 return ExprError(); 13725 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13726 13727 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13728 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13729 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13730 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13731 return ExprError(); 13732 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13733 13734 break; 13735 } 13736 } 13737 13738 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13739 PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty() 13740 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 13741 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 13742 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange()) 13743 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 13744 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13745 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()); 13746 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this, 13747 OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13748 return ExprError(); 13749 } 13750 13751 case OR_Ambiguous: 13752 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13753 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13754 << "[]" << Args[0]->getType() 13755 << Args[1]->getType() 13756 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13757 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13758 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13759 return ExprError(); 13760 13761 case OR_Deleted: 13762 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13763 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13764 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13765 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13766 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13767 return ExprError(); 13768 } 13769 13770 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13771 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 13772 } 13773 13774 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 13775 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 13776 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 13777 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 13778 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 13779 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 13780 /// member function. 13781 ExprResult 13782 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 13783 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13784 MultiExprArg Args, 13785 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13786 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 13787 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 13788 13789 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 13790 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 13791 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 13792 13793 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 13794 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 13795 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 13796 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 13797 13798 QualType fnType = 13799 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13800 13801 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 13802 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 13803 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 13804 13805 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 13806 // member function we're calling. 13807 Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals(); 13808 13809 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 13810 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 13811 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13812 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 13813 13814 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 13815 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 13816 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 13817 if (difference) { 13818 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 13819 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 13820 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 13821 << qualsString 13822 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 13823 } 13824 13825 CXXMemberCallExpr *call = 13826 CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, 13827 valueKind, RParenLoc, proto->getNumParams()); 13828 13829 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), 13830 call, nullptr)) 13831 return ExprError(); 13832 13833 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 13834 return ExprError(); 13835 13836 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 13837 return ExprError(); 13838 13839 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 13840 } 13841 13842 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 13843 return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, 13844 RParenLoc); 13845 13846 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 13847 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 13848 return ExprError(); 13849 13850 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 13851 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 13852 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 13853 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 13854 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 13855 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 13856 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 13857 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 13858 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 13859 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 13860 } else { 13861 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 13862 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 13863 13864 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 13865 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 13866 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 13867 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 13868 13869 // Add overload candidates 13870 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13871 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13872 13873 // FIXME: avoid copy. 13874 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 13875 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 13876 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 13877 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 13878 } 13879 13880 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 13881 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 13882 13883 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 13884 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 13885 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 13886 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 13887 13888 13889 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 13890 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 13891 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, 13892 CandidateSet, 13893 /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false); 13894 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 13895 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 13896 // non-template member function. 13897 if (TemplateArgs) 13898 continue; 13899 13900 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 13901 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 13902 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 13903 } else { 13904 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 13905 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 13906 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 13907 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 13908 } 13909 } 13910 13911 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 13912 13913 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 13914 13915 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13916 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(), 13917 Best)) { 13918 case OR_Success: 13919 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 13920 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 13921 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 13922 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 13923 return ExprError(); 13924 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 13925 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 13926 // called on both. 13927 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 13928 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 13929 // being used. 13930 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 13931 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 13932 return ExprError(); 13933 break; 13934 13935 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13936 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13937 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13938 UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13939 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 13940 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 13941 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13942 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 13943 return ExprError(); 13944 13945 case OR_Ambiguous: 13946 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13947 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13948 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 13949 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 13950 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 13951 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 13952 return ExprError(); 13953 13954 case OR_Deleted: 13955 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13956 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13957 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 13958 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 13959 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13960 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 13961 return ExprError(); 13962 } 13963 13964 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 13965 13966 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 13967 // non-member call based on that function. 13968 if (Method->isStatic()) { 13969 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 13970 RParenLoc); 13971 } 13972 13973 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 13974 } 13975 13976 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 13977 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 13978 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13979 13980 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 13981 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 13982 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 13983 CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, 13984 RParenLoc, Proto->getNumParams()); 13985 13986 // Check for a valid return type. 13987 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13988 TheCall, Method)) 13989 return ExprError(); 13990 13991 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 13992 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 13993 // it was done at lookup. 13994 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 13995 ExprResult ObjectArg = 13996 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 13997 FoundDecl, Method); 13998 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 13999 return ExprError(); 14000 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 14001 } 14002 14003 // Convert the rest of the arguments 14004 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 14005 RParenLoc)) 14006 return ExprError(); 14007 14008 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14009 14010 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14011 return ExprError(); 14012 14013 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 14014 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 14015 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 14016 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14017 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 14018 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 14019 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14020 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 14021 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 14022 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 14023 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 14024 return ExprError(); 14025 } 14026 } 14027 14028 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 14029 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 14030 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 14031 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 14032 14033 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 14034 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 14035 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14036 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 14037 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 14038 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 14039 14040 Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 14041 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14042 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 14043 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName() << MD->getDeclName(); 14044 } 14045 } 14046 14047 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 14048 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 14049 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 14050 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 14051 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 14052 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 14053 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 14054 } 14055 14056 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14057 } 14058 14059 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 14060 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 14061 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 14062 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 14063 ExprResult 14064 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 14065 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14066 MultiExprArg Args, 14067 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14068 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 14069 return ExprError(); 14070 ExprResult Object = Obj; 14071 14072 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14073 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14074 return ExprError(); 14075 14076 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 14077 "Requires object type argument"); 14078 14079 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 14080 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 14081 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 14082 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 14083 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 14084 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 14085 // (E).operator(). 14086 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 14087 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14088 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 14089 14090 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 14091 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 14092 return true; 14093 14094 const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>(); 14095 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14096 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 14097 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14098 14099 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14100 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14101 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 14102 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 14103 /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14104 } 14105 14106 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 14107 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 14108 // declared in T of the form 14109 // 14110 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 14111 // 14112 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 14113 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 14114 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 14115 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 14116 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 14117 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 14118 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 14119 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 14120 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 14121 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 14122 // within T by another intervening declaration. 14123 const auto &Conversions = 14124 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 14125 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 14126 NamedDecl *D = *I; 14127 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 14128 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 14129 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 14130 14131 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 14132 // surrogates. 14133 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14134 continue; 14135 14136 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 14137 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 14138 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 14139 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 14140 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 14141 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 14142 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 14143 14144 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14145 { 14146 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 14147 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 14148 } 14149 } 14150 } 14151 14152 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14153 14154 // Perform overload resolution. 14155 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14156 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14157 Best)) { 14158 case OR_Success: 14159 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 14160 // below. 14161 break; 14162 14163 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14164 PartialDiagnostic PD = 14165 CandidateSet.empty() 14166 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14167 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 14168 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()) 14169 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 14170 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange()); 14171 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14172 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this, 14173 OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14174 break; 14175 } 14176 case OR_Ambiguous: 14177 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14178 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14179 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 14180 << Object.get()->getType() 14181 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14182 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14183 break; 14184 14185 case OR_Deleted: 14186 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14187 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14188 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 14189 << Object.get()->getType() 14190 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14191 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14192 break; 14193 } 14194 14195 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 14196 return true; 14197 14198 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14199 14200 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 14201 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 14202 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 14203 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 14204 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 14205 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 14206 14207 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 14208 Best->FoundDecl); 14209 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 14210 return ExprError(); 14211 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14212 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 14213 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 14214 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 14215 // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job. 14216 14217 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 14218 // and then call it. 14219 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 14220 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 14221 if (Call.isInvalid()) 14222 return ExprError(); 14223 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 14224 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 14225 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 14226 nullptr, VK_RValue); 14227 14228 return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 14229 } 14230 14231 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14232 14233 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 14234 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 14235 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 14236 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14237 14238 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 14239 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 14240 return ExprError(); 14241 14242 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14243 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 14244 14245 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 14246 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 14247 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 14248 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14249 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 14250 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14251 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14252 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 14253 return true; 14254 14255 // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default 14256 // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally 14257 // need one more slot for the object parameter. 14258 unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams); 14259 14260 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 14261 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 14262 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots); 14263 14264 bool IsError = false; 14265 14266 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 14267 ExprResult ObjRes = 14268 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14269 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14270 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 14271 IsError = true; 14272 else 14273 Object = ObjRes; 14274 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 14275 14276 // Check the argument types. 14277 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 14278 Expr *Arg; 14279 if (i < Args.size()) { 14280 Arg = Args[i]; 14281 14282 // Pass the argument. 14283 14284 ExprResult InputInit 14285 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14286 Context, 14287 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 14288 SourceLocation(), Arg); 14289 14290 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 14291 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14292 } else { 14293 ExprResult DefArg 14294 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 14295 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 14296 IsError = true; 14297 break; 14298 } 14299 14300 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 14301 } 14302 14303 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg; 14304 } 14305 14306 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 14307 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 14308 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 14309 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 14310 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 14311 nullptr); 14312 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 14313 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get(); 14314 } 14315 } 14316 14317 if (IsError) 14318 return true; 14319 14320 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14321 14322 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned. 14323 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14324 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14325 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14326 14327 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 14328 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, 14329 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, FPOptions()); 14330 14331 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14332 return true; 14333 14334 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14335 return true; 14336 14337 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14338 } 14339 14340 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 14341 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 14342 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 14343 ExprResult 14344 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 14345 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14346 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 14347 "left-hand side must have class type"); 14348 14349 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 14350 return ExprError(); 14351 14352 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 14353 14354 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 14355 // 14356 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 14357 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 14358 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 14359 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 14360 DeclarationName OpName = 14361 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 14362 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14363 14364 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 14365 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 14366 return ExprError(); 14367 14368 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14369 LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 14370 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14371 14372 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14373 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14374 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 14375 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14376 } 14377 14378 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14379 14380 // Perform overload resolution. 14381 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14382 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 14383 case OR_Success: 14384 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 14385 break; 14386 14387 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14388 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14389 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 14390 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 14391 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14392 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 14393 // diagnostic, as requested. 14394 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 14395 return ExprError(); 14396 } 14397 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 14398 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 14399 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 14400 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 14401 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 14402 } 14403 } else 14404 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 14405 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 14406 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands); 14407 return ExprError(); 14408 } 14409 case OR_Ambiguous: 14410 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14411 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 14412 << "->" << Base->getType() 14413 << Base->getSourceRange()), 14414 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base); 14415 return ExprError(); 14416 14417 case OR_Deleted: 14418 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14419 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14420 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()), 14421 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14422 return ExprError(); 14423 } 14424 14425 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14426 14427 // Convert the object parameter. 14428 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14429 ExprResult BaseResult = 14430 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14431 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14432 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 14433 return ExprError(); 14434 Base = BaseResult.get(); 14435 14436 // Build the operator call. 14437 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14438 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 14439 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14440 return ExprError(); 14441 14442 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14443 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14444 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14445 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14446 Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 14447 14448 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14449 return ExprError(); 14450 14451 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14452 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14453 return ExprError(); 14454 14455 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14456 } 14457 14458 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 14459 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 14460 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 14461 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 14462 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 14463 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 14464 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 14465 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 14466 14467 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 14468 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14469 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, 14470 TemplateArgs); 14471 14472 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14473 14474 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 14475 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 14476 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14477 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 14478 case OR_Success: 14479 case OR_Deleted: 14480 break; 14481 14482 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14483 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14484 PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc, 14485 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 14486 << R.getLookupName()), 14487 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14488 return ExprError(); 14489 14490 case OR_Ambiguous: 14491 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14492 PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 14493 << R.getLookupName()), 14494 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14495 return ExprError(); 14496 } 14497 14498 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 14499 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 14500 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 14501 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 14502 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 14503 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14504 return true; 14505 14506 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 14507 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 14508 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 14509 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 14510 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 14511 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 14512 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 14513 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14514 return true; 14515 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 14516 } 14517 14518 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 14519 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14520 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14521 14522 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create( 14523 Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy, 14524 VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 14525 14526 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 14527 return ExprError(); 14528 14529 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 14530 return ExprError(); 14531 14532 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 14533 } 14534 14535 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 14536 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 14537 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 14538 /// dependent lookup. 14539 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 14540 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 14541 /// is returned. 14542 Sema::ForRangeStatus 14543 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 14544 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 14545 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 14546 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 14547 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 14548 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 14549 Scope *S = nullptr; 14550 14551 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14552 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 14553 ExprResult MemberRef = 14554 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 14555 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 14556 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 14557 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 14558 MemberLookup, 14559 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 14560 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 14561 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14562 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14563 } 14564 *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 14565 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 14566 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14567 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14568 } 14569 } else { 14570 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames; 14571 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = 14572 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 14573 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo, 14574 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false, 14575 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end()); 14576 14577 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 14578 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 14579 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 14580 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14581 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14582 } 14583 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14584 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 14585 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 14586 14587 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 14588 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14589 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14590 } 14591 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 14592 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 14593 OverloadResult, 14594 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 14595 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 14596 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14597 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14598 } 14599 } 14600 return FRS_Success; 14601 } 14602 14603 14604 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 14605 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 14606 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 14607 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 14608 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 14609 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 14610 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 14611 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 14612 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 14613 Found, Fn); 14614 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 14615 return PE; 14616 14617 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 14618 } 14619 14620 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 14621 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 14622 Found, Fn); 14623 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 14624 SubExpr->getType()) && 14625 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 14626 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 14627 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 14628 return ICE; 14629 14630 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 14631 ICE->getCastKind(), 14632 SubExpr, nullptr, 14633 ICE->getValueKind()); 14634 } 14635 14636 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 14637 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 14638 Expr *SubExpr = 14639 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 14640 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 14641 return GSE; 14642 14643 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 14644 // selection expression. 14645 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 14646 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 14647 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 14648 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 14649 14650 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 14651 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 14652 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 14653 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 14654 ResultIdx); 14655 } 14656 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 14657 // selection expression. 14658 return GSE; 14659 } 14660 14661 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 14662 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 14663 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 14664 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 14665 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14666 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 14667 // from non-member functions. 14668 } else { 14669 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 14670 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 14671 // or template. 14672 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 14673 Found, Fn); 14674 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 14675 return UnOp; 14676 14677 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 14678 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 14679 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 14680 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 14681 14682 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 14683 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 14684 // appropriate pointer to member type. 14685 QualType ClassType 14686 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 14687 QualType MemPtrType 14688 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 14689 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 14690 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 14691 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 14692 14693 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 14694 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 14695 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false); 14696 } 14697 } 14698 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 14699 Found, Fn); 14700 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 14701 return UnOp; 14702 14703 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 14704 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 14705 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 14706 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false); 14707 } 14708 14709 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 14710 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14711 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14712 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14713 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14714 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14715 } 14716 14717 DeclRefExpr *DRE = 14718 BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(), 14719 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 14720 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 14721 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 14722 return DRE; 14723 } 14724 14725 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 14726 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14727 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14728 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14729 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14730 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14731 } 14732 14733 Expr *Base; 14734 14735 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 14736 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 14737 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 14738 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 14739 DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr( 14740 Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(), 14741 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 14742 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 14743 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 14744 return DRE; 14745 } else { 14746 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 14747 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 14748 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 14749 Base = 14750 BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true); 14751 } 14752 } else 14753 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 14754 14755 ExprValueKind valueKind; 14756 QualType type; 14757 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 14758 valueKind = VK_LValue; 14759 type = Fn->getType(); 14760 } else { 14761 valueKind = VK_RValue; 14762 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 14763 } 14764 14765 return BuildMemberExpr( 14766 Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 14767 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 14768 /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 14769 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs); 14770 } 14771 14772 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 14773 } 14774 14775 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 14776 DeclAccessPair Found, 14777 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 14778 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 14779 } 14780